1 //===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // This file implements semantic analysis for expressions. 11 // 12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 15 #include "TreeTransform.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h" 28 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 32 #include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h" 33 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" 34 #include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h" 35 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 36 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 37 #include "clang/Sema/Designator.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 45 #include "llvm/Support/ConvertUTF.h" 46 using namespace clang; 47 using namespace sema; 48 49 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without 50 /// emitting diagnostics. 51 bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D) { 52 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 53 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) 54 return false; 55 56 // See if this is a deleted function. 57 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 58 if (FD->isDeleted()) 59 return false; 60 61 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 62 // then we can't use it either. 63 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 64 DeduceReturnType(FD, SourceLocation(), /*Diagnose*/ false)) 65 return false; 66 } 67 68 // See if this function is unavailable. 69 if (D->getAvailability() == AR_Unavailable && 70 cast<Decl>(CurContext)->getAvailability() != AR_Unavailable) 71 return false; 72 73 return true; 74 } 75 76 static void DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) { 77 // Warn if this is used but marked unused. 78 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 79 const Decl *DC = cast_or_null<Decl>(S.getCurObjCLexicalContext()); 80 if (DC && !DC->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 81 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName(); 82 } 83 } 84 85 static bool HasRedeclarationWithoutAvailabilityInCategory(const Decl *D) { 86 const auto *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D); 87 if (!OMD) 88 return false; 89 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OID = OMD->getClassInterface(); 90 if (!OID) 91 return false; 92 93 for (const ObjCCategoryDecl *Cat : OID->visible_categories()) 94 if (ObjCMethodDecl *CatMeth = 95 Cat->getMethod(OMD->getSelector(), OMD->isInstanceMethod())) 96 if (!CatMeth->hasAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()) 97 return true; 98 return false; 99 } 100 101 static AvailabilityResult 102 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 103 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass, 104 bool ObjCPropertyAccess) { 105 // See if this declaration is unavailable or deprecated. 106 std::string Message; 107 108 // Forward class declarations get their attributes from their definition. 109 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) { 110 if (IDecl->getDefinition()) 111 D = IDecl->getDefinition(); 112 } 113 AvailabilityResult Result = D->getAvailability(&Message); 114 if (const EnumConstantDecl *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D)) 115 if (Result == AR_Available) { 116 const DeclContext *DC = ECD->getDeclContext(); 117 if (const EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(DC)) 118 Result = TheEnumDecl->getAvailability(&Message); 119 } 120 121 const ObjCPropertyDecl *ObjCPDecl = nullptr; 122 if (Result == AR_Deprecated || Result == AR_Unavailable || 123 AR_NotYetIntroduced) { 124 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) { 125 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = MD->findPropertyDecl()) { 126 AvailabilityResult PDeclResult = PD->getAvailability(nullptr); 127 if (PDeclResult == Result) 128 ObjCPDecl = PD; 129 } 130 } 131 } 132 133 switch (Result) { 134 case AR_Available: 135 break; 136 137 case AR_Deprecated: 138 if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Deprecated) 139 S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Deprecation, 140 D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl, 141 ObjCPropertyAccess); 142 break; 143 144 case AR_NotYetIntroduced: { 145 // Don't do this for enums, they can't be redeclared. 146 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<EnumDecl>(D)) 147 break; 148 149 bool Warn = !D->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()->isInherited(); 150 // Objective-C method declarations in categories are not modelled as 151 // redeclarations, so manually look for a redeclaration in a category 152 // if necessary. 153 if (Warn && HasRedeclarationWithoutAvailabilityInCategory(D)) 154 Warn = false; 155 // In general, D will point to the most recent redeclaration. However, 156 // for `@class A;` decls, this isn't true -- manually go through the 157 // redecl chain in that case. 158 if (Warn && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) 159 for (Decl *Redecl = D->getMostRecentDecl(); Redecl && Warn; 160 Redecl = Redecl->getPreviousDecl()) 161 if (!Redecl->hasAttr<AvailabilityAttr>() || 162 Redecl->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()->isInherited()) 163 Warn = false; 164 165 if (Warn) 166 S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Partial, D, Message, Loc, 167 UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl, 168 ObjCPropertyAccess); 169 break; 170 } 171 172 case AR_Unavailable: 173 if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Unavailable) 174 S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Unavailable, 175 D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl, 176 ObjCPropertyAccess); 177 break; 178 179 } 180 return Result; 181 } 182 183 /// \brief Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted. 184 void Sema::NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *Decl) { 185 assert(Decl->isDeleted()); 186 187 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl); 188 189 if (Method && Method->isDeleted() && Method->isDefaulted()) { 190 // If the method was explicitly defaulted, point at that declaration. 191 if (!Method->isImplicit()) 192 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_implicitly_deleted); 193 194 // Try to diagnose why this special member function was implicitly 195 // deleted. This might fail, if that reason no longer applies. 196 CXXSpecialMember CSM = getSpecialMember(Method); 197 if (CSM != CXXInvalid) 198 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Method, CSM, /*Diagnose=*/true); 199 200 return; 201 } 202 203 if (CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Decl)) { 204 if (CXXConstructorDecl *BaseCD = 205 const_cast<CXXConstructorDecl*>(CD->getInheritedConstructor())) { 206 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_inherited_deleted_here); 207 if (BaseCD->isDeleted()) { 208 NoteDeletedFunction(BaseCD); 209 } else { 210 // FIXME: An explanation of why exactly it can't be inherited 211 // would be nice. 212 Diag(BaseCD->getLocation(), diag::note_cannot_inherit); 213 } 214 return; 215 } 216 } 217 218 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_availability_specified_here) 219 << Decl << true; 220 } 221 222 /// \brief Determine whether a FunctionDecl was ever declared with an 223 /// explicit storage class. 224 static bool hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl *D) { 225 for (auto I : D->redecls()) { 226 if (I->getStorageClass() != SC_None) 227 return true; 228 } 229 return false; 230 } 231 232 /// \brief Check whether we're in an extern inline function and referring to a 233 /// variable or function with internal linkage (C11 6.7.4p3). 234 /// 235 /// This is only a warning because we used to silently accept this code, but 236 /// in many cases it will not behave correctly. This is not enabled in C++ mode 237 /// because the restriction language is a bit weaker (C++11 [basic.def.odr]p6) 238 /// and so while there may still be user mistakes, most of the time we can't 239 /// prove that there are errors. 240 static void diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema &S, 241 const NamedDecl *D, 242 SourceLocation Loc) { 243 // This is disabled under C++; there are too many ways for this to fire in 244 // contexts where the warning is a false positive, or where it is technically 245 // correct but benign. 246 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 247 return; 248 249 // Check if this is an inlined function or method. 250 FunctionDecl *Current = S.getCurFunctionDecl(); 251 if (!Current) 252 return; 253 if (!Current->isInlined()) 254 return; 255 if (!Current->isExternallyVisible()) 256 return; 257 258 // Check if the decl has internal linkage. 259 if (D->getFormalLinkage() != InternalLinkage) 260 return; 261 262 // Downgrade from ExtWarn to Extension if 263 // (1) the supposedly external inline function is in the main file, 264 // and probably won't be included anywhere else. 265 // (2) the thing we're referencing is a pure function. 266 // (3) the thing we're referencing is another inline function. 267 // This last can give us false negatives, but it's better than warning on 268 // wrappers for simple C library functions. 269 const FunctionDecl *UsedFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 270 bool DowngradeWarning = S.getSourceManager().isInMainFile(Loc); 271 if (!DowngradeWarning && UsedFn) 272 DowngradeWarning = UsedFn->isInlined() || UsedFn->hasAttr<ConstAttr>(); 273 274 S.Diag(Loc, DowngradeWarning ? diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline_quiet 275 : diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline) 276 << /*IsVar=*/!UsedFn << D; 277 278 S.MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(Current); 279 280 S.Diag(D->getCanonicalDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 281 << D; 282 } 283 284 void Sema::MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *Cur) { 285 const FunctionDecl *First = Cur->getFirstDecl(); 286 287 // Suggest "static" on the function, if possible. 288 if (!hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(First)) { 289 SourceLocation DeclBegin = First->getSourceRange().getBegin(); 290 Diag(DeclBegin, diag::note_convert_inline_to_static) 291 << Cur << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DeclBegin, "static "); 292 } 293 } 294 295 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and 296 /// emit any corresponding diagnostics. 297 /// 298 /// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing 299 /// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example, 300 /// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being 301 /// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted 302 /// function is being used. 303 /// 304 /// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be 305 /// referenced), false otherwise. 306 /// 307 bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 308 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass, 309 bool ObjCPropertyAccess) { 310 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 311 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction, 312 // emit them now. 313 SuppressedDiagnosticsMap::iterator 314 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl()); 315 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) { 316 SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second; 317 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I) 318 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second); 319 320 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit 321 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this 322 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these 323 // diagnostics again. 324 Suppressed.clear(); 325 } 326 327 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3: 328 // The function 'main' shall not be used within a program. 329 if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isMain()) 330 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_main_used); 331 } 332 333 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 334 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) { 335 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer) 336 << D->getDeclName(); 337 return true; 338 } 339 340 // See if this is a deleted function. 341 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 342 if (FD->isDeleted()) { 343 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use); 344 NoteDeletedFunction(FD); 345 return true; 346 } 347 348 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 349 // then we can't use it either. 350 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 351 DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc)) 352 return true; 353 } 354 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(*this, D, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, 355 ObjCPropertyAccess); 356 357 DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(*this, D, Loc); 358 359 diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(*this, D, Loc); 360 361 return false; 362 } 363 364 /// \brief Retrieve the message suffix that should be added to a 365 /// diagnostic complaining about the given function being deleted or 366 /// unavailable. 367 std::string Sema::getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 368 std::string Message; 369 if (FD->getAvailability(&Message)) 370 return ": " + Message; 371 372 return std::string(); 373 } 374 375 /// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or 376 /// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and 377 /// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are 378 /// satisfied. 379 void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 380 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 381 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>(); 382 if (!attr) 383 return; 384 385 // The number of formal parameters of the declaration. 386 unsigned numFormalParams; 387 388 // The kind of declaration. This is also an index into a %select in 389 // the diagnostic. 390 enum CalleeType { CT_Function, CT_Method, CT_Block } calleeType; 391 392 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) { 393 numFormalParams = MD->param_size(); 394 calleeType = CT_Method; 395 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 396 numFormalParams = FD->param_size(); 397 calleeType = CT_Function; 398 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(D)) { 399 QualType type = cast<ValueDecl>(D)->getType(); 400 const FunctionType *fn = nullptr; 401 if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 402 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 403 if (!fn) return; 404 calleeType = CT_Function; 405 } else if (const BlockPointerType *ptr = type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 406 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 407 calleeType = CT_Block; 408 } else { 409 return; 410 } 411 412 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn)) { 413 numFormalParams = proto->getNumParams(); 414 } else { 415 numFormalParams = 0; 416 } 417 } else { 418 return; 419 } 420 421 // "nullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which 422 // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments. This is 423 // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters, 424 // but the language forces you to have at least one. 425 unsigned nullPos = attr->getNullPos(); 426 assert((nullPos == 0 || nullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel"); 427 numFormalParams = (nullPos > numFormalParams ? 0 : numFormalParams - nullPos); 428 429 // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel. 430 unsigned numArgsAfterSentinel = attr->getSentinel(); 431 432 // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters, 433 // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain. 434 if (Args.size() < numFormalParams + numArgsAfterSentinel + 1) { 435 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName(); 436 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 437 return; 438 } 439 440 // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression. 441 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[Args.size() - numArgsAfterSentinel - 1]; 442 if (!sentinelExpr) return; 443 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return; 444 if (Context.isSentinelNullExpr(sentinelExpr)) return; 445 446 // Pick a reasonable string to insert. Optimistically use 'nil', 'nullptr', 447 // or 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context. Only use 448 // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the 449 // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers. 450 SourceLocation MissingNilLoc 451 = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(sentinelExpr->getLocEnd()); 452 std::string NullValue; 453 if (calleeType == CT_Method && PP.isMacroDefined("nil")) 454 NullValue = "nil"; 455 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 456 NullValue = "nullptr"; 457 else if (PP.isMacroDefined("NULL")) 458 NullValue = "NULL"; 459 else 460 NullValue = "(void*) 0"; 461 462 if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid()) 463 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << int(calleeType); 464 else 465 Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) 466 << int(calleeType) 467 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue); 468 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 469 } 470 471 SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const { 472 return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange(); 473 } 474 475 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 476 // Standard Promotions and Conversions 477 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 478 479 /// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4). 480 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E) { 481 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 482 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 483 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 484 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 485 E = result.get(); 486 } 487 488 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 489 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type"); 490 491 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 492 // If we are here, we are not calling a function but taking 493 // its address (which is not allowed in OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3). 494 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 495 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address); 496 return ExprError(); 497 } 498 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 499 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 500 } else if (Ty->isArrayType()) { 501 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is 502 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has 503 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer 504 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression 505 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue" 506 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99). 507 // 508 // C++ 4.2p1: 509 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of 510 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T". 511 // 512 if (getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue()) 513 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty), 514 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 515 } 516 return E; 517 } 518 519 static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 520 // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer. If so, 521 // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the 522 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this 523 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This 524 // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check. 525 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 526 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref && 527 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()-> 528 isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) && 529 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) { 530 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 531 S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null) 532 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange()); 533 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 534 S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null)); 535 } 536 } 537 538 static void DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema &S, const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE, 539 SourceLocation AssignLoc, 540 const Expr* RHS) { 541 const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = OIRE->getDecl(); 542 if (!IV) 543 return; 544 545 DeclarationName MemberName = IV->getDeclName(); 546 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 547 if (!Member || !Member->isStr("isa")) 548 return; 549 550 const Expr *Base = OIRE->getBase(); 551 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 552 if (OIRE->isArrow()) 553 BaseType = BaseType->getPointeeType(); 554 if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) 555 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface()) { 556 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared = nullptr; 557 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared); 558 if (!ClassDeclared->getSuperClass() 559 && (*ClassDeclared->ivar_begin()) == IV) { 560 if (RHS) { 561 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = 562 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 563 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 564 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 565 if (ObjectSetClass) { 566 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS->getLocEnd()); 567 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) << 568 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") << 569 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), 570 AssignLoc), ",") << 571 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 572 } 573 else 574 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 575 } else { 576 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = 577 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 578 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 579 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 580 if (ObjectGetClass) 581 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) << 582 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") << 583 FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 584 SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), 585 OIRE->getLocEnd()), ")"); 586 else 587 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 588 } 589 S.Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_ivar_decl); 590 } 591 } 592 } 593 594 ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) { 595 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 596 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 597 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 598 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 599 E = result.get(); 600 } 601 602 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 603 // A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be 604 // converted to a prvalue. 605 if (!E->isGLValue()) return E; 606 607 QualType T = E->getType(); 608 assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?"); 609 610 // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of 611 // expressions of certain types in C++. 612 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 613 (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy || 614 T->isDependentType() || 615 T->isRecordType())) 616 return E; 617 618 // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and 619 // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why. It's 620 // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo 621 // lvalue-to-rvalue at all. Note that expressions of unqualified 622 // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be. 623 if (T->isVoidType()) 624 return E; 625 626 // OpenCL usually rejects direct accesses to values of 'half' type. 627 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp16 && 628 T->isHalfType()) { 629 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_load_store) 630 << 0 << T; 631 return ExprError(); 632 } 633 634 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E); 635 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 636 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 637 &Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 638 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 639 if (ObjectGetClass) 640 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) << 641 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OISA->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") << 642 FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 643 SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OISA->getIsaMemberLoc()), ")"); 644 else 645 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 646 } 647 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 648 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 649 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, SourceLocation(), /* Expr*/nullptr); 650 651 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 652 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the 653 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the 654 // rvalue is T. 655 // 656 // C99 6.3.2.1p2: 657 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified 658 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the 659 // type of the lvalue. 660 if (T.hasQualifiers()) 661 T = T.getUnqualifiedType(); 662 663 UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E); 664 665 // Loading a __weak object implicitly retains the value, so we need a cleanup to 666 // balance that. 667 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 668 E->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 669 ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 670 671 ExprResult Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_LValueToRValue, E, 672 nullptr, VK_RValue); 673 674 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 675 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 676 // of the type of the lvalue ... 677 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = T->getAs<AtomicType>()) { 678 T = Atomic->getValueType().getUnqualifiedType(); 679 Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_AtomicToNonAtomic, Res.get(), 680 nullptr, VK_RValue); 681 } 682 683 return Res; 684 } 685 686 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E) { 687 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E); 688 if (Res.isInvalid()) 689 return ExprError(); 690 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 691 if (Res.isInvalid()) 692 return ExprError(); 693 return Res; 694 } 695 696 /// CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion 697 /// performed on a function designator of a call expression. 698 ExprResult Sema::CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 699 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 700 ExprResult Res = E; 701 // Only do implicit cast for a function type, but not for a pointer 702 // to function type. 703 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 704 Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 705 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 706 if (Res.isInvalid()) 707 return ExprError(); 708 } 709 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 710 if (Res.isInvalid()) 711 return ExprError(); 712 return Res.get(); 713 } 714 715 /// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most 716 /// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are 717 /// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't 718 /// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators. 719 /// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called. 720 ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 721 // First, convert to an r-value. 722 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 723 if (Res.isInvalid()) 724 return ExprError(); 725 E = Res.get(); 726 727 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 728 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type"); 729 730 // Half FP have to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported 731 if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) 732 return ImpCastExprToType(Res.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast); 733 734 // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically 735 // promotable type. 736 if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 737 // C99 6.3.1.1p2: 738 // 739 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or 740 // unsigned int may be used: 741 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer 742 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int 743 // and unsigned int. 744 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int. 745 // 746 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the 747 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an 748 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All 749 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions. 750 751 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E); 752 if (!PTy.isNull()) { 753 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 754 return E; 755 } 756 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 757 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty); 758 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 759 return E; 760 } 761 } 762 return E; 763 } 764 765 /// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that 766 /// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float or __fp16 767 /// are promoted to double. All other argument types are converted by 768 /// UsualUnaryConversions(). 769 ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) { 770 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 771 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type"); 772 773 ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 774 if (Res.isInvalid()) 775 return ExprError(); 776 E = Res.get(); 777 778 // If this is a 'float' or '__fp16' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to 779 // double. 780 const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 781 if (BTy && (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half || 782 BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)) 783 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 784 785 // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument 786 // promotion, even on class types, but note: 787 // C++11 [conv.lval]p2: 788 // When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated 789 // operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the 790 // referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue 791 // has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary 792 // of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion 793 // is a prvalue for the temporary. 794 // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in 795 // potentially potentially evaluated contexts. 796 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() && !isUnevaluatedContext()) { 797 ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization( 798 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()), 799 E->getExprLoc(), E); 800 if (Temp.isInvalid()) 801 return ExprError(); 802 E = Temp.get(); 803 } 804 805 return E; 806 } 807 808 /// Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression. 809 /// Incomplete types are considered POD, since this check can be performed 810 /// when we're in an unevaluated context. 811 Sema::VarArgKind Sema::isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty) { 812 if (Ty->isIncompleteType()) { 813 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 814 // After these conversions, if the argument does not have arithmetic, 815 // enumeration, pointer, pointer to member, or class type, the program 816 // is ill-formed. 817 // 818 // Since we've already performed array-to-pointer and function-to-pointer 819 // decay, the only such type in C++ is cv void. This also handles 820 // initializer lists as variadic arguments. 821 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 822 return VAK_Invalid; 823 824 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 825 return VAK_Invalid; 826 return VAK_Valid; 827 } 828 829 if (Ty.isCXX98PODType(Context)) 830 return VAK_Valid; 831 832 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 833 // Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9) 834 // having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor, 835 // or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter, 836 // is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics. 837 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Ty->isDependentType()) 838 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 839 if (!Record->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor() && 840 !Record->hasNonTrivialMoveConstructor() && 841 !Record->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 842 return VAK_ValidInCXX11; 843 844 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Ty->isObjCLifetimeType()) 845 return VAK_Valid; 846 847 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 848 return VAK_Invalid; 849 850 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 851 return VAK_MSVCUndefined; 852 853 // FIXME: In C++11, these cases are conditionally-supported, meaning we're 854 // permitted to reject them. We should consider doing so. 855 return VAK_Undefined; 856 } 857 858 void Sema::checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT) { 859 // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg. 860 const QualType &Ty = E->getType(); 861 VarArgKind VAK = isValidVarArgType(Ty); 862 863 // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs. 864 switch (VAK) { 865 case VAK_ValidInCXX11: 866 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 867 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 868 PDiag(diag::warn_cxx98_compat_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) 869 << Ty << CT); 870 // Fall through. 871 case VAK_Valid: 872 if (Ty->isRecordType()) { 873 // This is unlikely to be what the user intended. If the class has a 874 // 'c_str' member function, the user probably meant to call that. 875 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 876 PDiag(diag::warn_pass_class_arg_to_vararg) 877 << Ty << CT << hasCStrMethod(E) << ".c_str()"); 878 } 879 break; 880 881 case VAK_Undefined: 882 case VAK_MSVCUndefined: 883 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 884 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 885 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) 886 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 << Ty << CT); 887 break; 888 889 case VAK_Invalid: 890 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 891 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 892 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 893 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg) 894 << Ty << CT); 895 else 896 Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_cannot_pass_to_vararg) 897 << isa<InitListExpr>(E) << Ty << CT; 898 break; 899 } 900 } 901 902 /// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but 903 /// will create a trap if the resulting type is not a POD type. 904 ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT, 905 FunctionDecl *FDecl) { 906 if (const BuiltinType *PlaceholderTy = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 907 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 908 if (PlaceholderTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 909 (CT == VariadicMethod || 910 (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>()))) { 911 E = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 912 913 // Otherwise, do normal placeholder checking. 914 } else { 915 ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 916 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 917 return ExprError(); 918 E = ExprRes.get(); 919 } 920 } 921 922 ExprResult ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E); 923 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 924 return ExprError(); 925 E = ExprRes.get(); 926 927 // Diagnostics regarding non-POD argument types are 928 // emitted along with format string checking in Sema::CheckFunctionCall(). 929 if (isValidVarArgType(E->getType()) == VAK_Undefined) { 930 // Turn this into a trap. 931 CXXScopeSpec SS; 932 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 933 UnqualifiedId Name; 934 Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"), 935 E->getLocStart()); 936 ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, TemplateKWLoc, 937 Name, true, false); 938 if (TrapFn.isInvalid()) 939 return ExprError(); 940 941 ExprResult Call = ActOnCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(), 942 E->getLocStart(), None, 943 E->getLocEnd()); 944 if (Call.isInvalid()) 945 return ExprError(); 946 947 ExprResult Comma = ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getLocStart(), tok::comma, 948 Call.get(), E); 949 if (Comma.isInvalid()) 950 return ExprError(); 951 return Comma.get(); 952 } 953 954 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 955 RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), E->getType(), 956 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)) 957 return ExprError(); 958 959 return E; 960 } 961 962 /// \brief Converts an integer to complex float type. Helper function of 963 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 964 /// 965 /// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is 966 /// successfully converted to the complex type. 967 static bool handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr, 968 ExprResult &ComplexExpr, 969 QualType IntTy, 970 QualType ComplexTy, 971 bool SkipCast) { 972 if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true; 973 if (SkipCast) return false; 974 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 975 QualType fpTy = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType(); 976 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating); 977 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 978 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 979 } else { 980 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 981 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 982 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 983 } 984 return false; 985 } 986 987 /// \brief Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types. Helper function of 988 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 989 static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 990 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 991 QualType RHSType, 992 bool IsCompAssign) { 993 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type. 994 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 995 /*skipCast*/false)) 996 return LHSType; 997 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 998 /*skipCast*/IsCompAssign)) 999 return RHSType; 1000 1001 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex. 1002 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the 1003 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds 1004 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands. 1005 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains. 1006 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real 1007 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's 1008 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example, 1009 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the 1010 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex". 1011 1012 // Compute the rank of the two types, regardless of whether they are complex. 1013 int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1014 1015 auto *LHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(LHSType); 1016 auto *RHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(RHSType); 1017 QualType LHSElementType = 1018 LHSComplexType ? LHSComplexType->getElementType() : LHSType; 1019 QualType RHSElementType = 1020 RHSComplexType ? RHSComplexType->getElementType() : RHSType; 1021 1022 QualType ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(LHSElementType); 1023 if (Order < 0) { 1024 // Promote the precision of the LHS if not an assignment. 1025 ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(RHSElementType); 1026 if (!IsCompAssign) { 1027 if (LHSComplexType) 1028 LHS = 1029 S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 1030 else 1031 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast); 1032 } 1033 } else if (Order > 0) { 1034 // Promote the precision of the RHS. 1035 if (RHSComplexType) 1036 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 1037 else 1038 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast); 1039 } 1040 return ResultType; 1041 } 1042 1043 /// \brief Hande arithmetic conversion from integer to float. Helper function 1044 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1045 static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr, 1046 ExprResult &IntExpr, 1047 QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy, 1048 bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) { 1049 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 1050 if (ConvertInt) 1051 // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type. 1052 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), FloatTy, 1053 CK_IntegralToFloating); 1054 return FloatTy; 1055 } 1056 1057 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float. 1058 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 1059 QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy); 1060 1061 // _Complex int -> _Complex float 1062 if (ConvertInt) 1063 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), result, 1064 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 1065 1066 // float -> _Complex float 1067 if (ConvertFloat) 1068 FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.get(), result, 1069 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 1070 1071 return result; 1072 } 1073 1074 /// \brief Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types. Helper 1075 /// function of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1076 static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1077 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1078 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1079 bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1080 bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1081 1082 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand 1083 // to the bigger result. 1084 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) { 1085 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1086 if (order > 0) { 1087 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1088 return LHSType; 1089 } 1090 1091 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison"); 1092 if (!IsCompAssign) 1093 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1094 return RHSType; 1095 } 1096 1097 if (LHSFloat) 1098 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1099 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign, 1100 /*convertInt=*/ true); 1101 assert(RHSFloat); 1102 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 1103 /*convertInt=*/ true, 1104 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign); 1105 } 1106 1107 typedef ExprResult PerformCastFn(Sema &S, Expr *operand, QualType toType); 1108 1109 namespace { 1110 /// These helper callbacks are placed in an anonymous namespace to 1111 /// permit their use as function template parameters. 1112 ExprResult doIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1113 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, toType, CK_IntegralCast); 1114 } 1115 1116 ExprResult doComplexIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1117 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, S.Context.getComplexType(toType), 1118 CK_IntegralComplexCast); 1119 } 1120 } 1121 1122 /// \brief Handle integer arithmetic conversions. Helper function of 1123 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 1124 template <PerformCastFn doLHSCast, PerformCastFn doRHSCast> 1125 static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1126 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1127 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1128 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8 1129 int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1130 bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1131 bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1132 if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) { 1133 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type 1134 if (order >= 0) { 1135 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1136 return LHSType; 1137 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1138 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1139 return RHSType; 1140 } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) { 1141 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the 1142 // signed type, so use the unsigned type 1143 if (RHSSigned) { 1144 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1145 return LHSType; 1146 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1147 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1148 return RHSType; 1149 } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) { 1150 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that 1151 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so 1152 // use the signed type. 1153 if (LHSSigned) { 1154 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1155 return LHSType; 1156 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1157 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1158 return RHSType; 1159 } else { 1160 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type, 1161 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long 1162 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding 1163 // to the signed type. 1164 QualType result = 1165 S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType); 1166 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), result); 1167 if (!IsCompAssign) 1168 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), result); 1169 return result; 1170 } 1171 } 1172 1173 /// \brief Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension. Helper function 1174 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1175 static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1176 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1177 QualType RHSType, 1178 bool IsCompAssign) { 1179 const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1180 const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1181 1182 if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) { 1183 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1184 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1185 QualType ScalarType = 1186 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1187 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1188 1189 return S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1190 } 1191 1192 if (LHSComplexInt) { 1193 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1194 QualType ScalarType = 1195 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1196 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1197 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1198 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ComplexType, 1199 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1200 1201 return ComplexType; 1202 } 1203 1204 assert(RHSComplexInt); 1205 1206 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1207 QualType ScalarType = 1208 handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1209 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1210 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1211 1212 if (!IsCompAssign) 1213 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ComplexType, 1214 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1215 return ComplexType; 1216 } 1217 1218 /// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to 1219 /// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this 1220 /// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is 1221 /// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics. 1222 QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 1223 bool IsCompAssign) { 1224 if (!IsCompAssign) { 1225 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 1226 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 1227 return QualType(); 1228 } 1229 1230 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 1231 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 1232 return QualType(); 1233 1234 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 1235 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 1236 QualType LHSType = 1237 Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1238 QualType RHSType = 1239 Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1240 1241 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any atomic qualifier on the LHS. 1242 if (const AtomicType *AtomicLHS = LHSType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1243 LHSType = AtomicLHS->getValueType(); 1244 1245 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1246 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1247 return LHSType; 1248 1249 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done. 1250 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int). 1251 if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType()) 1252 return QualType(); 1253 1254 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type. 1255 QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType; 1256 if (LHSType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 1257 LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType); 1258 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 1259 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull()) 1260 LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy; 1261 if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && !IsCompAssign) 1262 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast); 1263 1264 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1265 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1266 return LHSType; 1267 1268 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types. 1269 1270 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1). 1271 if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType()) 1272 return handleComplexFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1273 IsCompAssign); 1274 1275 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double). 1276 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) 1277 return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1278 IsCompAssign); 1279 1280 // Handle GCC complex int extension. 1281 if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType()) 1282 return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1283 IsCompAssign); 1284 1285 // Finally, we have two differing integer types. 1286 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1287 (*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1288 } 1289 1290 1291 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1292 // Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types 1293 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1294 1295 1296 ExprResult 1297 Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1298 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1299 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1300 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1301 ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes, 1302 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs) { 1303 unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size(); 1304 assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size()); 1305 1306 TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs]; 1307 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1308 if (ArgTypes[i]) 1309 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ArgTypes[i], &Types[i]); 1310 else 1311 Types[i] = nullptr; 1312 } 1313 1314 ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1315 ControllingExpr, 1316 llvm::makeArrayRef(Types, NumAssocs), 1317 ArgExprs); 1318 delete [] Types; 1319 return ER; 1320 } 1321 1322 ExprResult 1323 Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1324 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1325 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1326 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1327 ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types, 1328 ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs) { 1329 unsigned NumAssocs = Types.size(); 1330 assert(NumAssocs == Exprs.size()); 1331 if (ControllingExpr->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 1332 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(ControllingExpr); 1333 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 1334 ControllingExpr = result.get(); 1335 } 1336 1337 // The controlling expression is an unevaluated operand, so side effects are 1338 // likely unintended. 1339 if (ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() && 1340 ControllingExpr->HasSideEffects(Context, false)) 1341 Diag(ControllingExpr->getExprLoc(), 1342 diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context); 1343 1344 bool TypeErrorFound = false, 1345 IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent(), 1346 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack 1347 = ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(); 1348 1349 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1350 if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1351 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1352 1353 if (Types[i]) { 1354 if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1355 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1356 1357 if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) { 1358 IsResultDependent = true; 1359 } else { 1360 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a 1361 // complete object type other than a variably modified type." 1362 unsigned D = 0; 1363 if (Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) 1364 D = diag::err_assoc_type_incomplete; 1365 else if (!Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType()) 1366 D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject; 1367 else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 1368 D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified; 1369 1370 if (D != 0) { 1371 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D) 1372 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1373 << Types[i]->getType(); 1374 TypeErrorFound = true; 1375 } 1376 1377 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic 1378 // selection shall specify compatible types." 1379 for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j) 1380 if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() && 1381 Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(), 1382 Types[j]->getType())) { 1383 Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1384 diag::err_assoc_compatible_types) 1385 << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1386 << Types[j]->getType() 1387 << Types[i]->getType(); 1388 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1389 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1390 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1391 << Types[i]->getType(); 1392 TypeErrorFound = true; 1393 } 1394 } 1395 } 1396 } 1397 if (TypeErrorFound) 1398 return ExprError(); 1399 1400 // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't 1401 // try to compute the result expression. 1402 if (IsResultDependent) 1403 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr( 1404 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1405 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack); 1406 1407 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices; 1408 unsigned DefaultIndex = -1U; 1409 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1410 if (!Types[i]) 1411 DefaultIndex = i; 1412 else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(ControllingExpr->getType(), 1413 Types[i]->getType())) 1414 CompatIndices.push_back(i); 1415 } 1416 1417 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have 1418 // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic 1419 // association list." 1420 if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) { 1421 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1422 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1423 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1424 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match) 1425 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType() 1426 << (unsigned) CompatIndices.size(); 1427 for (SmallVectorImpl<unsigned>::iterator I = CompatIndices.begin(), 1428 E = CompatIndices.end(); I != E; ++I) { 1429 Diag(Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1430 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1431 << Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1432 << Types[*I]->getType(); 1433 } 1434 return ExprError(); 1435 } 1436 1437 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association, 1438 // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of 1439 // the types named in its generic association list." 1440 if (DefaultIndex == -1U && CompatIndices.size() == 0) { 1441 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1442 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1443 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1444 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match) 1445 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType(); 1446 return ExprError(); 1447 } 1448 1449 // C11 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a 1450 // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression, 1451 // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression 1452 // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the 1453 // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association." 1454 unsigned ResultIndex = 1455 CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex; 1456 1457 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr( 1458 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1459 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex); 1460 } 1461 1462 /// getUDSuffixLoc - Create a SourceLocation for a ud-suffix, given the 1463 /// location of the token and the offset of the ud-suffix within it. 1464 static SourceLocation getUDSuffixLoc(Sema &S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 1465 unsigned Offset) { 1466 return Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(TokLoc, Offset, S.getSourceManager(), 1467 S.getLangOpts()); 1468 } 1469 1470 /// BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall - A user-defined literal was found. Look up 1471 /// the corresponding cooked (non-raw) literal operator, and build a call to it. 1472 static ExprResult BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema &S, Scope *Scope, 1473 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix, 1474 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc, 1475 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 1476 SourceLocation LitEndLoc) { 1477 assert(Args.size() <= 2 && "too many arguments for literal operator"); 1478 1479 QualType ArgTy[2]; 1480 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 1481 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = Args[ArgIdx]->getType(); 1482 if (ArgTy[ArgIdx]->isArrayType()) 1483 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(ArgTy[ArgIdx]); 1484 } 1485 1486 DeclarationName OpName = 1487 S.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1488 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1489 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1490 1491 LookupResult R(S, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 1492 if (S.LookupLiteralOperator(Scope, R, llvm::makeArrayRef(ArgTy, Args.size()), 1493 /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false, 1494 /*AllowStringTemplate*/false) == Sema::LOLR_Error) 1495 return ExprError(); 1496 1497 return S.BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, LitEndLoc); 1498 } 1499 1500 /// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string 1501 /// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string 1502 /// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from 1503 /// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one 1504 /// string. 1505 /// 1506 ExprResult 1507 Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks, Scope *UDLScope) { 1508 assert(!StringToks.empty() && "Must have at least one string!"); 1509 1510 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP); 1511 if (Literal.hadError) 1512 return ExprError(); 1513 1514 SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs; 1515 for (unsigned i = 0; i != StringToks.size(); ++i) 1516 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation()); 1517 1518 QualType CharTy = Context.CharTy; 1519 StringLiteral::StringKind Kind = StringLiteral::Ascii; 1520 if (Literal.isWide()) { 1521 CharTy = Context.getWideCharType(); 1522 Kind = StringLiteral::Wide; 1523 } else if (Literal.isUTF8()) { 1524 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF8; 1525 } else if (Literal.isUTF16()) { 1526 CharTy = Context.Char16Ty; 1527 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF16; 1528 } else if (Literal.isUTF32()) { 1529 CharTy = Context.Char32Ty; 1530 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF32; 1531 } else if (Literal.isPascal()) { 1532 CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 1533 } 1534 1535 QualType CharTyConst = CharTy; 1536 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1). 1537 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || getLangOpts().ConstStrings) 1538 CharTyConst.addConst(); 1539 1540 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes 1541 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal 1542 // strings. 1543 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(CharTyConst, 1544 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1), 1545 ArrayType::Normal, 0); 1546 1547 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: a string literal is in the constant address space. 1548 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 1549 StrTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(StrTy, LangAS::opencl_constant); 1550 } 1551 1552 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory! 1553 StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(), 1554 Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy, 1555 &StringTokLocs[0], 1556 StringTokLocs.size()); 1557 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 1558 return Lit; 1559 1560 // We're building a user-defined literal. 1561 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 1562 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 1563 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()], 1564 Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 1565 1566 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 1567 if (!UDLScope) 1568 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl)); 1569 1570 // C++11 [lex.ext]p5: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 1571 // operator "" X (str, len) 1572 QualType SizeType = Context.getSizeType(); 1573 1574 DeclarationName OpName = 1575 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1576 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1577 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1578 1579 QualType ArgTy[] = { 1580 Context.getArrayDecayedType(StrTy), SizeType 1581 }; 1582 1583 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1584 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, ArgTy, 1585 /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false, 1586 /*AllowStringTemplate*/true)) { 1587 1588 case LOLR_Cooked: { 1589 llvm::APInt Len(Context.getIntWidth(SizeType), Literal.GetNumStringChars()); 1590 IntegerLiteral *LenArg = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Len, SizeType, 1591 StringTokLocs[0]); 1592 Expr *Args[] = { Lit, LenArg }; 1593 1594 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, StringTokLocs.back()); 1595 } 1596 1597 case LOLR_StringTemplate: { 1598 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 1599 1600 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(CharTy); 1601 bool CharIsUnsigned = CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 1602 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 1603 1604 TemplateArgument TypeArg(CharTy); 1605 TemplateArgumentLocInfo TypeArgInfo(Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharTy)); 1606 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(TypeArg, TypeArgInfo)); 1607 1608 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Lit->getLength(); I != N; ++I) { 1609 Value = Lit->getCodeUnit(I); 1610 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, CharTy); 1611 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 1612 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 1613 } 1614 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, StringTokLocs.back(), 1615 &ExplicitArgs); 1616 } 1617 case LOLR_Raw: 1618 case LOLR_Template: 1619 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1620 case LOLR_Error: 1621 return ExprError(); 1622 } 1623 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1624 } 1625 1626 ExprResult 1627 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1628 SourceLocation Loc, 1629 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) { 1630 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc); 1631 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS); 1632 } 1633 1634 /// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a 1635 /// declaration that does not require a closure capture. 1636 ExprResult 1637 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1638 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1639 const CXXScopeSpec *SS, NamedDecl *FoundD, 1640 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 1641 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 1642 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 1643 if (const FunctionDecl *Callee = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1644 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Callee)) { 1645 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_ref_bad_target) 1646 << IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) << D->getIdentifier() 1647 << IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller); 1648 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 1649 << D->getIdentifier(); 1650 return ExprError(); 1651 } 1652 } 1653 1654 bool RefersToCapturedVariable = 1655 isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1656 NeedToCaptureVariable(cast<VarDecl>(D), NameInfo.getLoc()); 1657 1658 DeclRefExpr *E; 1659 if (isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) { 1660 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec = 1661 cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D); 1662 1663 E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) 1664 : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 1665 VarSpec->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), D, 1666 RefersToCapturedVariable, NameInfo.getLoc(), Ty, VK, 1667 FoundD, TemplateArgs); 1668 } else { 1669 assert(!TemplateArgs && "No template arguments for non-variable" 1670 " template specialization references"); 1671 E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) 1672 : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 1673 SourceLocation(), D, RefersToCapturedVariable, 1674 NameInfo, Ty, VK, FoundD); 1675 } 1676 1677 MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 1678 1679 if (getLangOpts().ObjCARCWeak && isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1680 Ty.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak && 1681 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, E->getLocStart())) 1682 recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(E); 1683 1684 // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member. 1685 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D); 1686 if (FD && FD->isBitField()) 1687 E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField); 1688 1689 return E; 1690 } 1691 1692 /// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and 1693 /// possibly a list of template arguments. 1694 /// 1695 /// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call 1696 /// DecomposeTemplateName. 1697 /// 1698 /// This actually loses a lot of source location information for 1699 /// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in 1700 /// some way. 1701 void 1702 Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id, 1703 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer, 1704 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1705 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) { 1706 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) { 1707 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 1708 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 1709 1710 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 1711 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs); 1712 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer); 1713 1714 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get(); 1715 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 1716 NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 1717 TemplateArgs = &Buffer; 1718 } else { 1719 NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id); 1720 TemplateArgs = nullptr; 1721 } 1722 } 1723 1724 static void emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic( 1725 const TypoCorrection &TC, Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1726 DeclarationName Typo, SourceLocation TypoLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 1727 unsigned DiagnosticID, unsigned DiagnosticSuggestID) { 1728 DeclContext *Ctx = 1729 SS.isEmpty() ? nullptr : SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false); 1730 if (!TC) { 1731 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups. 1732 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?) 1733 if (Ctx) 1734 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Typo << Ctx 1735 << SS.getRange(); 1736 else 1737 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, DiagnosticID) << Typo; 1738 return; 1739 } 1740 1741 std::string CorrectedStr = TC.getAsString(SemaRef.getLangOpts()); 1742 bool DroppedSpecifier = 1743 TC.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Typo.getAsString() == CorrectedStr; 1744 unsigned NoteID = 1745 (TC.getCorrectionDecl() && isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(TC.getCorrectionDecl())) 1746 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl 1747 : diag::note_previous_decl; 1748 if (!Ctx) 1749 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(DiagnosticSuggestID) << Typo, 1750 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID)); 1751 else 1752 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest) 1753 << Typo << Ctx << DroppedSpecifier 1754 << SS.getRange(), 1755 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID)); 1756 } 1757 1758 /// Diagnose an empty lookup. 1759 /// 1760 /// \return false if new lookup candidates were found 1761 bool 1762 Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 1763 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC, 1764 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 1765 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, TypoExpr **Out) { 1766 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 1767 1768 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use; 1769 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 1770 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName || 1771 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName || 1772 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 1773 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use; 1774 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest; 1775 } 1776 1777 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an 1778 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the 1779 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a 1780 // dependent name. 1781 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isEmpty() && !CallsUndergoingInstantiation.empty()) 1782 ? CurContext : nullptr; 1783 while (DC) { 1784 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 1785 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 1786 1787 if (!R.empty()) { 1788 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup. 1789 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 1790 1791 // During a default argument instantiation the CurContext points 1792 // to a CXXMethodDecl; but we can't apply a this-> fixit inside a 1793 // function parameter list, hence add an explicit check. 1794 bool isDefaultArgument = !ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() && 1795 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.back().Kind == 1796 ActiveTemplateInstantiation::DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation; 1797 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext); 1798 bool isInstance = CurMethod && 1799 CurMethod->isInstance() && 1800 DC == CurMethod->getParent() && !isDefaultArgument; 1801 1802 1803 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'. 1804 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases. 1805 // Actually quite difficult! 1806 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 1807 diagnostic = diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup; 1808 if (isInstance) { 1809 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name 1810 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->"); 1811 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>( 1812 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee()); 1813 1814 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod; 1815 if (CurMethod->isDependentContext()) 1816 DepMethod = CurMethod; 1817 else if (CurMethod->getTemplatedKind() == 1818 FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplateSpecialization) 1819 DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurMethod->getPrimaryTemplate()-> 1820 getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()); 1821 else 1822 DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>( 1823 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()); 1824 assert(DepMethod && "No template pattern found"); 1825 1826 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context); 1827 CheckCXXThisCapture(R.getNameLoc()); 1828 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr( 1829 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false); 1830 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList; 1831 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 1832 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList); 1833 1834 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1835 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 1836 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr = 1837 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create( 1838 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(), 1839 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 1840 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), nullptr, 1841 R.getLookupNameInfo(), 1842 ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() ? &TList : nullptr); 1843 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr); 1844 } else { 1845 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 1846 } 1847 1848 // Do we really want to note all of these? 1849 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 1850 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use); 1851 1852 // Return true if we are inside a default argument instantiation 1853 // and the found name refers to an instance member function, otherwise 1854 // the function calling DiagnoseEmptyLookup will try to create an 1855 // implicit member call and this is wrong for default argument. 1856 if (isDefaultArgument && ((*R.begin())->isCXXInstanceMember())) { 1857 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_member_call_without_object); 1858 return true; 1859 } 1860 1861 // Tell the callee to try to recover. 1862 return false; 1863 } 1864 1865 R.clear(); 1866 } 1867 1868 // In Microsoft mode, if we are performing lookup from within a friend 1869 // function definition declared at class scope then we must set 1870 // DC to the lexical parent to be able to search into the parent 1871 // class. 1872 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isa<FunctionDecl>(DC) && 1873 cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)->getFriendObjectKind() && 1874 DC->getLexicalParent()->isRecord()) 1875 DC = DC->getLexicalParent(); 1876 else 1877 DC = DC->getParent(); 1878 } 1879 1880 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo. 1881 TypoCorrection Corrected; 1882 if (S && Out) { 1883 SourceLocation TypoLoc = R.getNameLoc(); 1884 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && 1885 "Diagnosing an empty lookup with explicit template args!"); 1886 *Out = CorrectTypoDelayed( 1887 R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, &SS, std::move(CCC), 1888 [=](const TypoCorrection &TC) { 1889 emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(TC, *this, SS, Name, TypoLoc, Args, 1890 diagnostic, diagnostic_suggest); 1891 }, 1892 nullptr, CTK_ErrorRecovery); 1893 if (*Out) 1894 return true; 1895 } else if (S && (Corrected = 1896 CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, 1897 &SS, std::move(CCC), CTK_ErrorRecovery))) { 1898 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 1899 bool DroppedSpecifier = 1900 Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Name.getAsString() == CorrectedStr; 1901 R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 1902 1903 bool AcceptableWithRecovery = false; 1904 bool AcceptableWithoutRecovery = false; 1905 NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl(); 1906 if (ND) { 1907 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 1908 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc(), 1909 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1910 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 1911 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(), 1912 CDEnd = Corrected.end(); 1913 CD != CDEnd; ++CD) { 1914 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = 1915 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*CD)) 1916 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 1917 FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 1918 Args, OCS); 1919 else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD)) 1920 if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0) 1921 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), 1922 Args, OCS); 1923 } 1924 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) { 1925 case OR_Success: 1926 ND = Best->Function; 1927 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 1928 break; 1929 default: 1930 // FIXME: Arbitrarily pick the first declaration for the note. 1931 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 1932 break; 1933 } 1934 } 1935 R.addDecl(ND); 1936 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ND->isCXXClassMember()) { 1937 CXXRecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 1938 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) { 1939 const Type *Ty = Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()->getAsType(); 1940 Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 1941 } 1942 if (!Record) 1943 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>( 1944 ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()); 1945 R.setNamingClass(Record); 1946 } 1947 1948 AcceptableWithRecovery = 1949 isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND); 1950 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or 1951 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser 1952 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo 1953 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going 1954 // to recover well anyway. 1955 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = 1956 isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND); 1957 } else { 1958 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it 1959 // because we aren't able to recover. 1960 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = true; 1961 } 1962 1963 if (AcceptableWithRecovery || AcceptableWithoutRecovery) { 1964 unsigned NoteID = (Corrected.getCorrectionDecl() && 1965 isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(Corrected.getCorrectionDecl())) 1966 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl 1967 : diag::note_previous_decl; 1968 if (SS.isEmpty()) 1969 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diagnostic_suggest) << Name, 1970 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 1971 else 1972 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest) 1973 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 1974 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange(), 1975 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 1976 1977 // Tell the callee whether to try to recover. 1978 return !AcceptableWithRecovery; 1979 } 1980 } 1981 R.clear(); 1982 1983 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups. 1984 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?) 1985 if (!SS.isEmpty()) { 1986 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 1987 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 1988 << SS.getRange(); 1989 return true; 1990 } 1991 1992 // Give up, we can't recover. 1993 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 1994 return true; 1995 } 1996 1997 /// In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class whose parent class has 1998 /// dependent base classes, and we can't resolve an unqualified identifier, then 1999 /// assume the identifier is a member of a dependent base class. We can only 2000 /// recover successfully in static methods, instance methods, and other contexts 2001 /// where 'this' is available. This doesn't precisely match MSVC's 2002 /// instantiation model, but it's close enough. 2003 static Expr * 2004 recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context, 2005 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 2006 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, 2007 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 2008 // Only try to recover from lookup into dependent bases in static methods or 2009 // contexts where 'this' is available. 2010 QualType ThisType = S.getCurrentThisType(); 2011 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 2012 if (!ThisType.isNull()) 2013 RD = ThisType->getPointeeType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 2014 else if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext)) 2015 RD = MD->getParent(); 2016 if (!RD || !RD->hasAnyDependentBases()) 2017 return nullptr; 2018 2019 // Diagnose this as unqualified lookup into a dependent base class. If 'this' 2020 // is available, suggest inserting 'this->' as a fixit. 2021 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2022 auto DB = S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base); 2023 DB << NameInfo.getName() << RD; 2024 2025 if (!ThisType.isNull()) { 2026 DB << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "this->"); 2027 return CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create( 2028 Context, /*This=*/nullptr, ThisType, /*IsArrow=*/true, 2029 /*Op=*/SourceLocation(), NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), TemplateKWLoc, 2030 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 2031 } 2032 2033 // Synthesize a fake NNS that points to the derived class. This will 2034 // perform name lookup during template instantiation. 2035 CXXScopeSpec SS; 2036 auto *NNS = 2037 NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, true, RD->getTypeForDecl()); 2038 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(Loc, Loc)); 2039 return DependentScopeDeclRefExpr::Create( 2040 Context, SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2041 TemplateArgs); 2042 } 2043 2044 ExprResult 2045 Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2046 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id, 2047 bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand, 2048 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC, 2049 bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier, Token *KeywordReplacement) { 2050 assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) && 2051 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen"); 2052 if (SS.isInvalid()) 2053 return ExprError(); 2054 2055 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer; 2056 2057 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data. 2058 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 2059 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs; 2060 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 2061 2062 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 2063 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 2064 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2065 2066 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3: 2067 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains: 2068 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type, 2069 // (note: handled after lookup) 2070 // -- a template-id that is dependent, 2071 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr) 2072 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type, 2073 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that 2074 // names a dependent type. 2075 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization; 2076 // we need to handle these differently. 2077 bool DependentID = false; 2078 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName && 2079 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) { 2080 DependentID = true; 2081 } else if (SS.isSet()) { 2082 if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) { 2083 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2084 return ExprError(); 2085 } else { 2086 DependentID = true; 2087 } 2088 } 2089 2090 if (DependentID) 2091 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2092 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2093 2094 // Perform the required lookup. 2095 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, 2096 (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam) 2097 ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam : LookupOrdinaryName); 2098 if (TemplateArgs) { 2099 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in 2100 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the 2101 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If 2102 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those 2103 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it. 2104 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 2105 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false, 2106 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization); 2107 2108 if (MemberOfUnknownSpecialization || 2109 (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)) 2110 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2111 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2112 } else { 2113 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = II && !SS.isSet() && getCurMethodDecl(); 2114 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp); 2115 2116 // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent 2117 // id-expression. 2118 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2119 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2120 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2121 2122 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do 2123 // some special Objective-C lookup, too. 2124 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) { 2125 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true)); 2126 if (E.isInvalid()) 2127 return ExprError(); 2128 2129 if (Expr *Ex = E.getAs<Expr>()) 2130 return Ex; 2131 } 2132 } 2133 2134 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2135 return ExprError(); 2136 2137 // This could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal in C90, 2138 // extension in C99, forbidden in C++). 2139 if (R.empty() && HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2140 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S); 2141 if (D) R.addDecl(D); 2142 } 2143 2144 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for 2145 // argument-dependent lookup. 2146 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen); 2147 2148 if (R.empty() && !ADL) { 2149 if (SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 2150 if (Expr *E = recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(*this, Context, NameInfo, 2151 TemplateKWLoc, TemplateArgs)) 2152 return E; 2153 } 2154 2155 // Don't diagnose an empty lookup for inline assembly. 2156 if (IsInlineAsmIdentifier) 2157 return ExprError(); 2158 2159 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function 2160 // call, diagnose the problem. 2161 TypoExpr *TE = nullptr; 2162 auto DefaultValidator = llvm::make_unique<CorrectionCandidateCallback>( 2163 II, SS.isValid() ? SS.getScopeRep() : nullptr); 2164 DefaultValidator->IsAddressOfOperand = IsAddressOfOperand; 2165 assert((!CCC || CCC->IsAddressOfOperand == IsAddressOfOperand) && 2166 "Typo correction callback misconfigured"); 2167 if (CCC) { 2168 // Make sure the callback knows what the typo being diagnosed is. 2169 CCC->setTypoName(II); 2170 if (SS.isValid()) 2171 CCC->setTypoNNS(SS.getScopeRep()); 2172 } 2173 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, 2174 CCC ? std::move(CCC) : std::move(DefaultValidator), 2175 nullptr, None, &TE)) { 2176 if (TE && KeywordReplacement) { 2177 auto &State = getTypoExprState(TE); 2178 auto BestTC = State.Consumer->getNextCorrection(); 2179 if (BestTC.isKeyword()) { 2180 auto *II = BestTC.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 2181 if (State.DiagHandler) 2182 State.DiagHandler(BestTC); 2183 KeywordReplacement->startToken(); 2184 KeywordReplacement->setKind(II->getTokenID()); 2185 KeywordReplacement->setIdentifierInfo(II); 2186 KeywordReplacement->setLocation(BestTC.getCorrectionRange().getBegin()); 2187 // Clean up the state associated with the TypoExpr, since it has 2188 // now been diagnosed (without a call to CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr). 2189 clearDelayedTypo(TE); 2190 // Signal that a correction to a keyword was performed by returning a 2191 // valid-but-null ExprResult. 2192 return (Expr*)nullptr; 2193 } 2194 State.Consumer->resetCorrectionStream(); 2195 } 2196 return TE ? TE : ExprError(); 2197 } 2198 2199 assert(!R.empty() && 2200 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results"); 2201 2202 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 2203 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 2204 // reference the ivar. 2205 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 2206 R.clear(); 2207 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier())); 2208 // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable 2209 // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it. 2210 if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get()) 2211 return ExprError(); 2212 return E; 2213 } 2214 } 2215 2216 // This is guaranteed from this point on. 2217 assert(!R.empty() || ADL); 2218 2219 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access. 2220 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3: 2221 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access 2222 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the 2223 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup 2224 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type 2225 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a 2226 // class member access expression using (*this) as the 2227 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator. 2228 // 2229 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R 2230 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the 2231 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a 2232 // non-static member function: 2233 // 2234 // C++ [expr.ref]p4: 2235 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . . 2236 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a 2237 // member function call. 2238 // 2239 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important 2240 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a 2241 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent 2242 // instance method. 2243 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 2244 bool MightBeImplicitMember; 2245 if (!IsAddressOfOperand) 2246 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2247 else if (!SS.isEmpty()) 2248 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2249 else if (R.isOverloadedResult()) 2250 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2251 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult()) 2252 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2253 else 2254 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2255 isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2256 isa<MSPropertyDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()); 2257 2258 if (MightBeImplicitMember) 2259 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, 2260 R, TemplateArgs); 2261 } 2262 2263 if (TemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) { 2264 2265 // In C++1y, if this is a variable template id, then check it 2266 // in BuildTemplateIdExpr(). 2267 // The single lookup result must be a variable template declaration. 2268 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId && Id.TemplateId && 2269 Id.TemplateId->Kind == TNK_Var_template) { 2270 assert(R.getAsSingle<VarTemplateDecl>() && 2271 "There should only be one declaration found."); 2272 } 2273 2274 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, ADL, TemplateArgs); 2275 } 2276 2277 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL); 2278 } 2279 2280 /// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified 2281 /// declaration name, generally during template instantiation. 2282 /// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along 2283 /// this path. 2284 ExprResult 2285 Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2286 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 2287 bool IsAddressOfOperand, 2288 TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI) { 2289 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 2290 if (!DC) 2291 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2292 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2293 2294 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2295 return ExprError(); 2296 2297 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName); 2298 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 2299 2300 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2301 return ExprError(); 2302 2303 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2304 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2305 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2306 2307 if (R.empty()) { 2308 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 2309 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange(); 2310 return ExprError(); 2311 } 2312 2313 if (const TypeDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>()) { 2314 // Diagnose a missing typename if this resolved unambiguously to a type in 2315 // a dependent context. If we can recover with a type, downgrade this to 2316 // a warning in Microsoft compatibility mode. 2317 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 2318 if (RecoveryTSI && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 2319 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 2320 SourceLocation Loc = SS.getBeginLoc(); 2321 auto D = Diag(Loc, DiagID); 2322 D << SS.getScopeRep() << NameInfo.getName().getAsString() 2323 << SourceRange(Loc, NameInfo.getEndLoc()); 2324 2325 // Don't recover if the caller isn't expecting us to or if we're in a SFINAE 2326 // context. 2327 if (!RecoveryTSI) 2328 return ExprError(); 2329 2330 // Only issue the fixit if we're prepared to recover. 2331 D << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "typename "); 2332 2333 // Recover by pretending this was an elaborated type. 2334 QualType Ty = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 2335 TypeLocBuilder TLB; 2336 TLB.pushTypeSpec(Ty).setNameLoc(NameInfo.getLoc()); 2337 2338 QualType ET = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, Ty); 2339 ElaboratedTypeLoc QTL = TLB.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(ET); 2340 QTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 2341 QTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 2342 2343 *RecoveryTSI = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, ET); 2344 2345 return ExprEmpty(); 2346 } 2347 2348 // Defend against this resolving to an implicit member access. We usually 2349 // won't get here if this might be a legitimate a class member (we end up in 2350 // BuildMemberReferenceExpr instead), but this can be valid if we're forming 2351 // a pointer-to-member or in an unevaluated context in C++11. 2352 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember() && !IsAddressOfOperand) 2353 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, 2354 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2355 R, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2356 2357 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /* ADL */ false); 2358 } 2359 2360 /// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has 2361 /// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some 2362 /// additional lookup. 2363 /// 2364 /// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's 2365 /// actually quite a lot of extra work involved. 2366 /// 2367 /// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success. 2368 ExprResult 2369 Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S, 2370 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2371 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc(); 2372 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 2373 2374 // Check for error condition which is already reported. 2375 if (!CurMethod) 2376 return ExprError(); 2377 2378 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed, 2379 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have 2380 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e. 2381 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with 2382 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl. 2383 2384 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for 2385 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an 2386 // ivar, that's an error. 2387 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod(); 2388 2389 bool LookForIvars; 2390 if (Lookup.empty()) 2391 LookForIvars = true; 2392 else if (IsClassMethod) 2393 LookForIvars = false; 2394 else 2395 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2396 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()); 2397 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 2398 if (LookForIvars) { 2399 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface(); 2400 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2401 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = nullptr; 2402 if (IFace && (IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared))) { 2403 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method. 2404 if (IsClassMethod) 2405 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2406 << IV->getDeclName()); 2407 2408 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent 2409 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl. 2410 if (IV->isInvalidDecl()) 2411 return ExprError(); 2412 2413 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)). 2414 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc)) 2415 return ExprError(); 2416 2417 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class. 2418 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private && 2419 !declaresSameEntity(ClassDeclared, IFace) && 2420 !getLangOpts().DebuggerSupport) 2421 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2422 2423 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't 2424 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something. 2425 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self"); 2426 UnqualifiedId SelfName; 2427 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation()); 2428 SelfName.setKind(UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam); 2429 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec; 2430 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 2431 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec, TemplateKWLoc, 2432 SelfName, false, false); 2433 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2434 return ExprError(); 2435 2436 SelfExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfExpr.get()); 2437 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2438 return ExprError(); 2439 2440 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, IV, true); 2441 2442 ObjCMethodFamily MF = CurMethod->getMethodFamily(); 2443 if (MF != OMF_init && MF != OMF_dealloc && MF != OMF_finalize && 2444 !IvarBacksCurrentMethodAccessor(IFace, CurMethod, IV)) 2445 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_direct_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2446 2447 ObjCIvarRefExpr *Result = new (Context) 2448 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc, IV->getLocation(), 2449 SelfExpr.get(), true, true); 2450 2451 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2452 if (IV->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) { 2453 if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, Loc)) 2454 recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(Result); 2455 } 2456 if (CurContext->isClosure()) 2457 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self) 2458 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "self->"); 2459 } 2460 2461 return Result; 2462 } 2463 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) { 2464 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar. 2465 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface()) { 2466 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2467 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) { 2468 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private || 2469 declaresSameEntity(IFace, ClassDeclared)) 2470 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName(); 2471 } 2472 } 2473 } else if (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2474 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()) { 2475 // If accessing a stand-alone ivar in a class method, this is an error. 2476 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Lookup.getFoundDecl())) 2477 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2478 << IV->getDeclName()); 2479 } 2480 2481 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2482 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName. 2483 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 2484 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2485 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) { 2486 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID, 2487 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(), 2488 Lookup.getNameLoc()); 2489 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D); 2490 } 2491 } 2492 } 2493 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special. 2494 return ExprResult((Expr *)nullptr); 2495 } 2496 2497 /// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type. 2498 /// 2499 /// Logically this happens in three phases: 2500 /// 2501 /// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class. 2502 /// The naming class is the class into which we were looking 2503 /// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a 2504 /// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type. 2505 /// 2506 /// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class. 2507 /// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by 2508 /// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's 2509 /// the class declaring the member. 2510 /// 2511 /// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true" 2512 /// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not 2513 /// obey access control. 2514 ExprResult 2515 Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From, 2516 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 2517 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 2518 NamedDecl *Member) { 2519 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext()); 2520 if (!RD) 2521 return From; 2522 2523 QualType DestRecordType; 2524 QualType DestType; 2525 QualType FromRecordType; 2526 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2527 bool PointerConversions = false; 2528 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) { 2529 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD)); 2530 2531 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2532 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType); 2533 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2534 PointerConversions = true; 2535 } else { 2536 DestType = DestRecordType; 2537 FromRecordType = FromType; 2538 } 2539 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) { 2540 if (Method->isStatic()) 2541 return From; 2542 2543 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context); 2544 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType(); 2545 2546 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2547 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2548 PointerConversions = true; 2549 } else { 2550 FromRecordType = FromType; 2551 DestType = DestRecordType; 2552 } 2553 } else { 2554 // No conversion necessary. 2555 return From; 2556 } 2557 2558 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType()) 2559 return From; 2560 2561 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary. 2562 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2563 return From; 2564 2565 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange(); 2566 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin(); 2567 2568 ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind(); 2569 2570 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8: 2571 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its 2572 // class name. 2573 // 2574 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a 2575 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type 2576 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows 2577 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as: 2578 // 2579 // class Base { public: int x; }; 2580 // class Derived1 : public Base { }; 2581 // class Derived2 : public Base { }; 2582 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); }; 2583 // 2584 // void VeryDerived::f() { 2585 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects 2586 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1 2587 // } 2588 if (Qualifier && Qualifier->getAsType()) { 2589 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0); 2590 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type"); 2591 2592 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0); 2593 2594 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base 2595 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it. 2596 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts. 2597 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) { 2598 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2599 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType, 2600 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2601 return ExprError(); 2602 2603 if (PointerConversions) 2604 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType); 2605 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2606 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2607 2608 FromType = QType; 2609 FromRecordType = QRecordType; 2610 2611 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type, 2612 // we're done. 2613 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2614 return From; 2615 } 2616 } 2617 2618 bool IgnoreAccess = false; 2619 2620 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast 2621 // down to the using declaration's type. 2622 // 2623 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a 2624 // class ever has member declarations. 2625 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) { 2626 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)); 2627 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType( 2628 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext())); 2629 2630 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class 2631 // conversion is non-trivial. 2632 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) { 2633 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType)); 2634 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2635 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType, 2636 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2637 return ExprError(); 2638 2639 QualType UType = URecordType; 2640 if (PointerConversions) 2641 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType); 2642 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2643 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2644 FromType = UType; 2645 FromRecordType = URecordType; 2646 } 2647 2648 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the 2649 // declaring class to the true declaring class. 2650 IgnoreAccess = true; 2651 } 2652 2653 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2654 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType, 2655 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath, 2656 IgnoreAccess)) 2657 return ExprError(); 2658 2659 return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2660 VK, &BasePath); 2661 } 2662 2663 bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2664 const LookupResult &R, 2665 bool HasTrailingLParen) { 2666 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call. 2667 if (!HasTrailingLParen) 2668 return false; 2669 2670 // Never if a scope specifier was provided. 2671 if (SS.isSet()) 2672 return false; 2673 2674 // Only in C++ or ObjC++. 2675 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 2676 return false; 2677 2678 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during 2679 // normal lookup: 2680 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) { 2681 NamedDecl *D = *I; 2682 2683 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2684 // -- a declaration of a class member 2685 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the 2686 // original decl. 2687 if (D->isCXXClassMember()) 2688 return false; 2689 2690 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2691 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 2692 // using-declaration 2693 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we 2694 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types 2695 // turn off ADL anyway). 2696 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 2697 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 2698 else if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 2699 return false; 2700 2701 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2702 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 2703 // template 2704 // And also for builtin functions. 2705 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2706 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 2707 2708 // But also builtin functions. 2709 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit()) 2710 return false; 2711 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 2712 return false; 2713 } 2714 2715 return true; 2716 } 2717 2718 2719 /// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration 2720 /// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that 2721 /// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration 2722 /// will in fact be used. 2723 static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) { 2724 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 2725 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName(); 2726 return true; 2727 } 2728 2729 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) { 2730 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName(); 2731 return true; 2732 } 2733 2734 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) { 2735 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName(); 2736 return true; 2737 } 2738 2739 return false; 2740 } 2741 2742 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2743 LookupResult &R, bool NeedsADL, 2744 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) { 2745 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL, 2746 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref. 2747 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>()) 2748 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getFoundDecl(), 2749 R.getRepresentativeDecl(), nullptr, 2750 AcceptInvalidDecl); 2751 2752 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one 2753 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be 2754 // functions and function templates. 2755 if (R.isSingleResult() && 2756 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl())) 2757 return ExprError(); 2758 2759 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress 2760 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when 2761 // we've picked a target. 2762 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 2763 2764 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE 2765 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(), 2766 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 2767 R.getLookupNameInfo(), 2768 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(), 2769 R.begin(), R.end()); 2770 2771 return ULE; 2772 } 2773 2774 /// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration. 2775 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr( 2776 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D, 2777 NamedDecl *FoundD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, 2778 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) { 2779 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration"); 2780 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) && 2781 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template"); 2782 2783 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2784 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D)) 2785 return ExprError(); 2786 2787 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) { 2788 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing 2789 // a template argument list. 2790 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref) << (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(D) ? 1 : 0) 2791 << Template << SS.getRange(); 2792 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here); 2793 return ExprError(); 2794 } 2795 2796 // Make sure that we're referring to a value. 2797 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 2798 if (!VD) { 2799 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value) 2800 << D << SS.getRange(); 2801 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 2802 return ExprError(); 2803 } 2804 2805 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress 2806 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup 2807 // on this function name, because this might not be the function 2808 // that overload resolution actually selects. 2809 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc)) 2810 return ExprError(); 2811 2812 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's. 2813 if (VD->isInvalidDecl() && !AcceptInvalidDecl) 2814 return ExprError(); 2815 2816 // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions. If we got here, 2817 // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this 2818 // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression. 2819 if (IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 2820 if (!indirectField->isCXXClassMember()) 2821 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(), 2822 indirectField); 2823 2824 { 2825 QualType type = VD->getType(); 2826 ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_RValue; 2827 2828 switch (D->getKind()) { 2829 // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds. 2830 #define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind) 2831 #define VALUE(type, base) 2832 #define DECL(type, base) \ 2833 case Decl::type: 2834 #include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc" 2835 llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind"); 2836 2837 // These shouldn't make it here. 2838 case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField: 2839 case Decl::ObjCIvar: 2840 llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?"); 2841 2842 // Enum constants are always r-values and never references. 2843 // Unresolved using declarations are dependent. 2844 case Decl::EnumConstant: 2845 case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue: 2846 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2847 break; 2848 2849 // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for 2850 // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for 2851 // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really 2852 // exist in the high-level semantics. 2853 case Decl::Field: 2854 case Decl::IndirectField: 2855 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2856 "building reference to field in C?"); 2857 2858 // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but 2859 // for internal consistency we do this anyway. 2860 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 2861 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2862 break; 2863 2864 // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values 2865 // depending on the type. 2866 case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: { 2867 if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 2868 type = reftype->getPointeeType(); 2869 valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference 2870 break; 2871 } 2872 2873 // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case 2874 // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever. 2875 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2876 type = type.getUnqualifiedType(); 2877 break; 2878 } 2879 2880 case Decl::Var: 2881 case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization: 2882 case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization: 2883 // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value. 2884 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2885 !type.hasQualifiers() && 2886 type->isVoidType()) { 2887 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2888 break; 2889 } 2890 // fallthrough 2891 2892 case Decl::ImplicitParam: 2893 case Decl::ParmVar: { 2894 // These are always l-values. 2895 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2896 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 2897 2898 // FIXME: Does the addition of const really only apply in 2899 // potentially-evaluated contexts? Since the variable isn't actually 2900 // captured in an unevaluated context, it seems that the answer is no. 2901 if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) { 2902 QualType CapturedType = getCapturedDeclRefType(cast<VarDecl>(VD), Loc); 2903 if (!CapturedType.isNull()) 2904 type = CapturedType; 2905 } 2906 2907 break; 2908 } 2909 2910 case Decl::Function: { 2911 if (unsigned BID = cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->getBuiltinID()) { 2912 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BID)) { 2913 type = Context.BuiltinFnTy; 2914 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2915 break; 2916 } 2917 } 2918 2919 const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>(); 2920 2921 // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype 2922 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 2923 if (fty->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 2924 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 2925 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2926 break; 2927 } 2928 2929 // Functions are l-values in C++. 2930 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2931 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2932 break; 2933 } 2934 2935 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a 2936 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only 2937 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing 2938 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function 2939 // type. 2940 if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() && 2941 isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty)) 2942 type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getReturnType(), 2943 fty->getExtInfo()); 2944 2945 // Functions are r-values in C. 2946 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2947 break; 2948 } 2949 2950 case Decl::MSProperty: 2951 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2952 break; 2953 2954 case Decl::CXXMethod: 2955 // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype 2956 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 2957 // This should only be possible with a type written directly. 2958 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto 2959 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType())) 2960 if (proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 2961 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 2962 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2963 break; 2964 } 2965 2966 // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static. 2967 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) { 2968 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2969 break; 2970 } 2971 // fallthrough 2972 2973 case Decl::CXXConversion: 2974 case Decl::CXXDestructor: 2975 case Decl::CXXConstructor: 2976 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2977 break; 2978 } 2979 2980 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS, FoundD, 2981 TemplateArgs); 2982 } 2983 } 2984 2985 static void ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth, StringRef Source, 2986 SmallString<32> &Target) { 2987 Target.resize(CharByteWidth * (Source.size() + 1)); 2988 char *ResultPtr = &Target[0]; 2989 const UTF8 *ErrorPtr; 2990 bool success = ConvertUTF8toWide(CharByteWidth, Source, ResultPtr, ErrorPtr); 2991 (void)success; 2992 assert(success); 2993 Target.resize(ResultPtr - &Target[0]); 2994 } 2995 2996 ExprResult Sema::BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, 2997 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT) { 2998 // Pick the current block, lambda, captured statement or function. 2999 Decl *currentDecl = nullptr; 3000 if (const BlockScopeInfo *BSI = getCurBlock()) 3001 currentDecl = BSI->TheDecl; 3002 else if (const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) 3003 currentDecl = LSI->CallOperator; 3004 else if (const CapturedRegionScopeInfo *CSI = getCurCapturedRegion()) 3005 currentDecl = CSI->TheCapturedDecl; 3006 else 3007 currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl(); 3008 3009 if (!currentDecl) { 3010 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function); 3011 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 3012 } 3013 3014 QualType ResTy; 3015 StringLiteral *SL = nullptr; 3016 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) 3017 ResTy = Context.DependentTy; 3018 else { 3019 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of 3020 // the string. 3021 auto Str = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl); 3022 unsigned Length = Str.length(); 3023 3024 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1); 3025 if (IT == PredefinedExpr::LFunction) { 3026 ResTy = Context.WideCharTy.withConst(); 3027 SmallString<32> RawChars; 3028 ConvertUTF8ToWideString(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ResTy).getQuantity(), 3029 Str, RawChars); 3030 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 3031 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0); 3032 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, RawChars, StringLiteral::Wide, 3033 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc); 3034 } else { 3035 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst(); 3036 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 3037 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0); 3038 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Str, StringLiteral::Ascii, 3039 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc); 3040 } 3041 } 3042 3043 return new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT, SL); 3044 } 3045 3046 ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 3047 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT; 3048 3049 switch (Kind) { 3050 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown simple primary expr!"); 3051 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2] 3052 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break; 3053 case tok::kw___FUNCDNAME__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncDName; break; // [MS] 3054 case tok::kw___FUNCSIG__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncSig; break; // [MS] 3055 case tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::LFunction; break; 3056 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break; 3057 } 3058 3059 return BuildPredefinedExpr(Loc, IT); 3060 } 3061 3062 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 3063 SmallString<16> CharBuffer; 3064 bool Invalid = false; 3065 StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid); 3066 if (Invalid) 3067 return ExprError(); 3068 3069 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(), 3070 PP, Tok.getKind()); 3071 if (Literal.hadError()) 3072 return ExprError(); 3073 3074 QualType Ty; 3075 if (Literal.isWide()) 3076 Ty = Context.WideCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C and C++. 3077 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 3078 Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C11 and C++11. 3079 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 3080 Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C11 and C++11. 3081 else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Literal.isMultiChar()) 3082 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' -> int in C, 'wxyz' -> int in C++. 3083 else 3084 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++ 3085 3086 CharacterLiteral::CharacterKind Kind = CharacterLiteral::Ascii; 3087 if (Literal.isWide()) 3088 Kind = CharacterLiteral::Wide; 3089 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 3090 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF16; 3091 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 3092 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF32; 3093 3094 Expr *Lit = new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty, 3095 Tok.getLocation()); 3096 3097 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 3098 return Lit; 3099 3100 // We're building a user-defined literal. 3101 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 3102 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 3103 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3104 3105 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3106 if (!UDLScope) 3107 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_character_udl)); 3108 3109 // C++11 [lex.ext]p6: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 3110 // operator "" X (ch) 3111 return BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(*this, UDLScope, UDSuffix, UDSuffixLoc, 3112 Lit, Tok.getLocation()); 3113 } 3114 3115 ExprResult Sema::ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, uint64_t Val) { 3116 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3117 return IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val), 3118 Context.IntTy, Loc); 3119 } 3120 3121 static Expr *BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema &S, NumericLiteralParser &Literal, 3122 QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc) { 3123 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty); 3124 3125 using llvm::APFloat; 3126 APFloat Val(Format); 3127 3128 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val); 3129 3130 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if 3131 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow). 3132 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) || 3133 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) { 3134 unsigned diagnostic; 3135 SmallString<20> buffer; 3136 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) { 3137 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow; 3138 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer); 3139 } else { 3140 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow; 3141 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer); 3142 } 3143 3144 S.Diag(Loc, diagnostic) 3145 << Ty 3146 << StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size()); 3147 } 3148 3149 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK); 3150 return FloatingLiteral::Create(S.Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Loc); 3151 } 3152 3153 bool Sema::CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 3154 assert(E && "Invalid expression"); 3155 3156 if (E->isValueDependent()) 3157 return false; 3158 3159 QualType QT = E->getType(); 3160 if (!QT->isIntegerType() || QT->isBooleanType() || QT->isCharType()) { 3161 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_type) << QT; 3162 return true; 3163 } 3164 3165 llvm::APSInt ValueAPS; 3166 ExprResult R = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, &ValueAPS); 3167 3168 if (R.isInvalid()) 3169 return true; 3170 3171 bool ValueIsPositive = ValueAPS.isStrictlyPositive(); 3172 if (!ValueIsPositive || ValueAPS.getActiveBits() > 31) { 3173 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_value) 3174 << ValueAPS.toString(10) << ValueIsPositive; 3175 return true; 3176 } 3177 3178 return false; 3179 } 3180 3181 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 3182 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit 3183 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or suffix. 3184 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) { 3185 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok); 3186 return ActOnIntegerConstant(Tok.getLocation(), Val-'0'); 3187 } 3188 3189 SmallString<128> SpellingBuffer; 3190 // NumericLiteralParser wants to overread by one character. Add padding to 3191 // the buffer in case the token is copied to the buffer. If getSpelling() 3192 // returns a StringRef to the memory buffer, it should have a null char at 3193 // the EOF, so it is also safe. 3194 SpellingBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength() + 1); 3195 3196 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc. 3197 bool Invalid = false; 3198 StringRef TokSpelling = PP.getSpelling(Tok, SpellingBuffer, &Invalid); 3199 if (Invalid) 3200 return ExprError(); 3201 3202 NumericLiteralParser Literal(TokSpelling, Tok.getLocation(), PP); 3203 if (Literal.hadError) 3204 return ExprError(); 3205 3206 if (Literal.hasUDSuffix()) { 3207 // We're building a user-defined literal. 3208 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 3209 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 3210 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3211 3212 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3213 if (!UDLScope) 3214 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_numeric_udl)); 3215 3216 QualType CookedTy; 3217 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3218 // C++11 [lex.ext]p4: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3219 // long double, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3220 // operator "" X (f L) 3221 CookedTy = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3222 } else { 3223 // C++11 [lex.ext]p3: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3224 // unsigned long long, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3225 // operator "" X (n ULL) 3226 CookedTy = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3227 } 3228 3229 DeclarationName OpName = 3230 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 3231 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 3232 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 3233 3234 SourceLocation TokLoc = Tok.getLocation(); 3235 3236 // Perform literal operator lookup to determine if we're building a raw 3237 // literal or a cooked one. 3238 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 3239 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, CookedTy, 3240 /*AllowRaw*/true, /*AllowTemplate*/true, 3241 /*AllowStringTemplate*/false)) { 3242 case LOLR_Error: 3243 return ExprError(); 3244 3245 case LOLR_Cooked: { 3246 Expr *Lit; 3247 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3248 Lit = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, CookedTy, Tok.getLocation()); 3249 } else { 3250 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(), 0); 3251 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) 3252 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large) 3253 << /* Unsigned */ 1; 3254 Lit = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, CookedTy, 3255 Tok.getLocation()); 3256 } 3257 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3258 } 3259 3260 case LOLR_Raw: { 3261 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: If S contains a raw literal operator, the 3262 // literal is treated as a call of the form 3263 // operator "" X ("n") 3264 unsigned Length = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); 3265 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType( 3266 Context.CharTy.withConst(), llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1), 3267 ArrayType::Normal, 0); 3268 Expr *Lit = StringLiteral::Create( 3269 Context, StringRef(TokSpelling.data(), Length), StringLiteral::Ascii, 3270 /*Pascal*/false, StrTy, &TokLoc, 1); 3271 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3272 } 3273 3274 case LOLR_Template: { 3275 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: Otherwise (S contains a literal operator 3276 // template), L is treated as a call fo the form 3277 // operator "" X <'c1', 'c2', ... 'ck'>() 3278 // where n is the source character sequence c1 c2 ... ck. 3279 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 3280 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(Context.CharTy); 3281 bool CharIsUnsigned = Context.CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 3282 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 3283 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); I != N; ++I) { 3284 Value = TokSpelling[I]; 3285 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, Context.CharTy); 3286 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 3287 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 3288 } 3289 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, TokLoc, 3290 &ExplicitArgs); 3291 } 3292 case LOLR_StringTemplate: 3293 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 3294 } 3295 } 3296 3297 Expr *Res; 3298 3299 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3300 QualType Ty; 3301 if (Literal.isFloat) 3302 Ty = Context.FloatTy; 3303 else if (!Literal.isLong) 3304 Ty = Context.DoubleTy; 3305 else 3306 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3307 3308 Res = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3309 3310 if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) { 3311 if (getLangOpts().SinglePrecisionConstants) { 3312 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3313 } else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 3314 !((getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 120) || 3315 getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp64)) { 3316 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64); 3317 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3318 } 3319 } 3320 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) { 3321 return ExprError(); 3322 } else { 3323 QualType Ty; 3324 3325 // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature. 3326 if (!getLangOpts().C99 && Literal.isLongLong) { 3327 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 3328 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), 3329 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 3330 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong); 3331 else 3332 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_longlong); 3333 } 3334 3335 // Get the value in the widest-possible width. 3336 unsigned MaxWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth(); 3337 // The microsoft literal suffix extensions support 128-bit literals, which 3338 // may be wider than [u]intmax_t. 3339 // FIXME: Actually, they don't. We seem to have accidentally invented the 3340 // i128 suffix. 3341 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 128 && MaxWidth < 128 && 3342 Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()) 3343 MaxWidth = 128; 3344 llvm::APInt ResultVal(MaxWidth, 0); 3345 3346 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) { 3347 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, error and force to ull. 3348 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large) 3349 << /* Unsigned */ 1; 3350 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3351 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() && 3352 "long long is not intmax_t?"); 3353 } else { 3354 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into 3355 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5. 3356 3357 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to 3358 // be an unsigned int. 3359 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10; 3360 3361 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can. 3362 unsigned Width = 0; 3363 3364 // Microsoft specific integer suffixes are explicitly sized. 3365 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) { 3366 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger > MaxWidth) { 3367 // If this target doesn't support __int128, error and force to ull. 3368 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_int128_unsupported); 3369 Width = MaxWidth; 3370 Ty = Context.getIntMaxType(); 3371 } else if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 8 && !Literal.isUnsigned) { 3372 Width = 8; 3373 Ty = Context.CharTy; 3374 } else { 3375 Width = Literal.MicrosoftInteger; 3376 Ty = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(Width, 3377 /*Signed=*/!Literal.isUnsigned); 3378 } 3379 } 3380 3381 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3382 // Are int/unsigned possibilities? 3383 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3384 3385 // Does it fit in a unsigned int? 3386 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) { 3387 // Does it fit in a signed int? 3388 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0) 3389 Ty = Context.IntTy; 3390 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3391 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 3392 Width = IntSize; 3393 } 3394 } 3395 3396 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities? 3397 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3398 unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 3399 3400 // Does it fit in a unsigned long? 3401 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) { 3402 // Does it fit in a signed long? 3403 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0) 3404 Ty = Context.LongTy; 3405 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3406 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 3407 Width = LongSize; 3408 } 3409 } 3410 3411 // Check long long if needed. 3412 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3413 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3414 3415 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long? 3416 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) { 3417 // Does it fit in a signed long long? 3418 // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the 3419 // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode. 3420 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 || 3421 (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && Literal.isLongLong))) 3422 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 3423 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3424 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3425 Width = LongLongSize; 3426 } 3427 } 3428 3429 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that 3430 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix. 3431 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3432 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_integer_literal_too_large_for_signed); 3433 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3434 Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3435 } 3436 3437 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width) 3438 ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width); 3439 } 3440 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3441 } 3442 3443 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper. 3444 if (Literal.isImaginary) 3445 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res, 3446 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType())); 3447 3448 return Res; 3449 } 3450 3451 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) { 3452 assert(E && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr"); 3453 return new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E); 3454 } 3455 3456 static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3457 SourceLocation Loc, 3458 SourceRange ArgRange) { 3459 // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in 3460 // scalar or vector data type argument..." 3461 // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic 3462 // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void. 3463 if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) { 3464 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type) 3465 << T << ArgRange; 3466 return true; 3467 } 3468 3469 assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) && 3470 "Scalar types should always be complete"); 3471 return false; 3472 } 3473 3474 static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3475 SourceLocation Loc, 3476 SourceRange ArgRange, 3477 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3478 // Invalid types must be hard errors for SFINAE in C++. 3479 if (S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus) 3480 return true; 3481 3482 // C99 6.5.3.4p1: 3483 if (T->isFunctionType() && 3484 (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf || TraitKind == UETT_AlignOf)) { 3485 // sizeof(function)/alignof(function) is allowed as an extension. 3486 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3487 << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3488 return false; 3489 } 3490 3491 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension, unless in OpenCL where 3492 // this is an error (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.k) 3493 if (T->isVoidType()) { 3494 unsigned DiagID = S.LangOpts.OpenCL ? diag::err_opencl_sizeof_alignof_type 3495 : diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_void_type; 3496 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3497 return false; 3498 } 3499 3500 return true; 3501 } 3502 3503 static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T, 3504 SourceLocation Loc, 3505 SourceRange ArgRange, 3506 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3507 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) if the 3508 // runtime doesn't allow it. 3509 if (!S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsSizeofAlignof() && T->isObjCObjectType()) { 3510 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface) 3511 << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf) 3512 << ArgRange; 3513 return true; 3514 } 3515 3516 return false; 3517 } 3518 3519 /// \brief Check whether E is a pointer from a decayed array type (the decayed 3520 /// pointer type is equal to T) and emit a warning if it is. 3521 static void warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, 3522 Expr *E) { 3523 // Don't warn if the operation changed the type. 3524 if (T != E->getType()) 3525 return; 3526 3527 // Now look for array decays. 3528 ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E); 3529 if (!ICE || ICE->getCastKind() != CK_ArrayToPointerDecay) 3530 return; 3531 3532 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_sizeof_array_decay) << ICE->getSourceRange() 3533 << ICE->getType() 3534 << ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(); 3535 } 3536 3537 /// \brief Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression 3538 /// and type traits. 3539 /// 3540 /// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand 3541 /// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may modify 3542 /// the expression as it completes the type for that expression through template 3543 /// instantiation, etc. 3544 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E, 3545 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3546 QualType ExprTy = E->getType(); 3547 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3548 3549 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3550 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3551 E->getSourceRange()); 3552 3553 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3554 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3555 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3556 return false; 3557 3558 // 'alignof' applied to an expression only requires the base element type of 3559 // the expression to be complete. 'sizeof' requires the expression's type to 3560 // be complete (and will attempt to complete it if it's an array of unknown 3561 // bound). 3562 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) { 3563 if (RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), 3564 Context.getBaseElementType(E->getType()), 3565 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, ExprKind, 3566 E->getSourceRange())) 3567 return true; 3568 } else { 3569 if (RequireCompleteExprType(E, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3570 ExprKind, E->getSourceRange())) 3571 return true; 3572 } 3573 3574 // Completing the expression's type may have changed it. 3575 ExprTy = E->getType(); 3576 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3577 3578 if (ExprTy->isFunctionType()) { 3579 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3580 << ExprKind << E->getSourceRange(); 3581 return true; 3582 } 3583 3584 // The operand for sizeof and alignof is in an unevaluated expression context, 3585 // so side effects could result in unintended consequences. 3586 if ((ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) && 3587 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() && E->HasSideEffects(Context, false)) 3588 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context); 3589 3590 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3591 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3592 return true; 3593 3594 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) { 3595 if (DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3596 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) { 3597 QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType(); 3598 QualType Type = PVD->getType(); 3599 if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) { 3600 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param) 3601 << Type << OType; 3602 Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 3603 } 3604 } 3605 } 3606 3607 // Warn on "sizeof(array op x)" and "sizeof(x op array)", where the array 3608 // decays into a pointer and returns an unintended result. This is most 3609 // likely a typo for "sizeof(array) op x". 3610 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3611 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3612 BO->getLHS()); 3613 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3614 BO->getRHS()); 3615 } 3616 } 3617 3618 return false; 3619 } 3620 3621 /// \brief Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type 3622 /// traits. 3623 /// 3624 /// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various constraints 3625 /// on those operands. 3626 /// 3627 /// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine. 3628 /// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state: 3629 /// Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ... 3630 /// 3631 /// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4 3632 /// The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer 3633 /// standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof. 3634 /// 3635 /// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions. 3636 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType, 3637 SourceLocation OpLoc, 3638 SourceRange ExprRange, 3639 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3640 if (ExprType->isDependentType()) 3641 return false; 3642 3643 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: 3644 // When applied to a reference or a reference type, the result 3645 // is the size of the referenced type. 3646 // C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3647 // When alignof is applied to a reference type, the result 3648 // shall be the alignment of the referenced type. 3649 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 3650 ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType(); 3651 3652 // C11 6.5.3.4/3, C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3653 // When alignof or _Alignof is applied to an array type, the result 3654 // is the alignment of the element type. 3655 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) 3656 ExprType = Context.getBaseElementType(ExprType); 3657 3658 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3659 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange); 3660 3661 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3662 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3663 ExprKind)) 3664 return false; 3665 3666 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, ExprType, 3667 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3668 ExprKind, ExprRange)) 3669 return true; 3670 3671 if (ExprType->isFunctionType()) { 3672 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3673 << ExprKind << ExprRange; 3674 return true; 3675 } 3676 3677 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3678 ExprKind)) 3679 return true; 3680 3681 return false; 3682 } 3683 3684 static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 3685 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 3686 3687 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 3688 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 3689 return false; 3690 3691 if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { 3692 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) 3693 << 1 << E->getSourceRange(); 3694 return true; 3695 } 3696 3697 ValueDecl *D = nullptr; 3698 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 3699 D = DRE->getDecl(); 3700 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 3701 D = ME->getMemberDecl(); 3702 } 3703 3704 // If it's a field, require the containing struct to have a 3705 // complete definition so that we can compute the layout. 3706 // 3707 // This can happen in C++11 onwards, either by naming the member 3708 // in a way that is not transformed into a member access expression 3709 // (in an unevaluated operand, for instance), or by naming the member 3710 // in a trailing-return-type. 3711 // 3712 // For the record, since __alignof__ on expressions is a GCC 3713 // extension, GCC seems to permit this but always gives the 3714 // nonsensical answer 0. 3715 // 3716 // We don't really need the layout here --- we could instead just 3717 // directly check for all the appropriate alignment-lowing 3718 // attributes --- but that would require duplicating a lot of 3719 // logic that just isn't worth duplicating for such a marginal 3720 // use-case. 3721 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) { 3722 // Fast path this check, since we at least know the record has a 3723 // definition if we can find a member of it. 3724 if (!FD->getParent()->isCompleteDefinition()) { 3725 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_alignof_member_of_incomplete_type) 3726 << E->getSourceRange(); 3727 return true; 3728 } 3729 3730 // Otherwise, if it's a field, and the field doesn't have 3731 // reference type, then it must have a complete type (or be a 3732 // flexible array member, which we explicitly want to 3733 // white-list anyway), which makes the following checks trivial. 3734 if (!FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 3735 return false; 3736 } 3737 3738 return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_AlignOf); 3739 } 3740 3741 bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) { 3742 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 3743 3744 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 3745 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 3746 return false; 3747 3748 return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep); 3749 } 3750 3751 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand. 3752 ExprResult 3753 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 3754 SourceLocation OpLoc, 3755 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, 3756 SourceRange R) { 3757 if (!TInfo) 3758 return ExprError(); 3759 3760 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 3761 3762 if (!T->isDependentType() && 3763 CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind)) 3764 return ExprError(); 3765 3766 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 3767 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 3768 ExprKind, TInfo, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, R.getEnd()); 3769 } 3770 3771 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression 3772 /// operand. 3773 ExprResult 3774 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc, 3775 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3776 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 3777 if (PE.isInvalid()) 3778 return ExprError(); 3779 3780 E = PE.get(); 3781 3782 // Verify that the operand is valid. 3783 bool isInvalid = false; 3784 if (E->isTypeDependent()) { 3785 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions. 3786 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) { 3787 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E); 3788 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) { 3789 isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E); 3790 } else if (E->refersToBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1. 3791 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0; 3792 isInvalid = true; 3793 } else { 3794 isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_SizeOf); 3795 } 3796 3797 if (isInvalid) 3798 return ExprError(); 3799 3800 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf && E->getType()->isVariableArrayType()) { 3801 PE = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 3802 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3803 E = PE.get(); 3804 } 3805 3806 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 3807 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 3808 ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 3809 } 3810 3811 /// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c 3812 /// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof 3813 /// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false. 3814 ExprResult 3815 Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, 3816 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType, 3817 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) { 3818 // If error parsing type, ignore. 3819 if (!TyOrEx) return ExprError(); 3820 3821 if (IsType) { 3822 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 3823 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo); 3824 return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange); 3825 } 3826 3827 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx; 3828 ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind); 3829 return Result; 3830 } 3831 3832 static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc, 3833 bool IsReal) { 3834 if (V.get()->isTypeDependent()) 3835 return S.Context.DependentTy; 3836 3837 // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values. 3838 if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) { 3839 V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.get()); 3840 if (V.isInvalid()) 3841 return QualType(); 3842 } 3843 3844 // These operators return the element type of a complex type. 3845 if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>()) 3846 return CT->getElementType(); 3847 3848 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here. 3849 if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType()) 3850 return V.get()->getType(); 3851 3852 // Test for placeholders. 3853 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get()); 3854 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 3855 if (PR.get() != V.get()) { 3856 V = PR; 3857 return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal); 3858 } 3859 3860 // Reject anything else. 3861 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType() 3862 << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag"); 3863 return QualType(); 3864 } 3865 3866 3867 3868 ExprResult 3869 Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 3870 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) { 3871 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 3872 switch (Kind) { 3873 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 3874 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break; 3875 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break; 3876 } 3877 3878 // Since this might is a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 3879 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Input); 3880 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3881 Input = Result.get(); 3882 3883 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 3884 } 3885 3886 /// \brief Diagnose if arithmetic on the given ObjC pointer is illegal. 3887 /// 3888 /// \return true on error 3889 static bool checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema &S, 3890 SourceLocation opLoc, 3891 Expr *op) { 3892 assert(op->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()); 3893 if (S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsPointerArithmetic() && 3894 !S.LangOpts.ObjCSubscriptingLegacyRuntime) 3895 return false; 3896 3897 S.Diag(opLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface) 3898 << op->getType()->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType() 3899 << op->getSourceRange(); 3900 return true; 3901 } 3902 3903 ExprResult 3904 Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *base, SourceLocation lbLoc, 3905 Expr *idx, SourceLocation rbLoc) { 3906 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 3907 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(base)) { 3908 ExprResult result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, base); 3909 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3910 base = result.get(); 3911 } 3912 3913 // Handle any non-overload placeholder types in the base and index 3914 // expressions. We can't handle overloads here because the other 3915 // operand might be an overloadable type, in which case the overload 3916 // resolution for the operator overload should get the first crack 3917 // at the overload. 3918 if (base->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 3919 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(base); 3920 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3921 base = result.get(); 3922 } 3923 if (idx->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 3924 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(idx); 3925 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3926 idx = result.get(); 3927 } 3928 3929 // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent. 3930 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3931 (base->isTypeDependent() || idx->isTypeDependent())) { 3932 return new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(base, idx, Context.DependentTy, 3933 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc); 3934 } 3935 3936 // Use C++ overloaded-operator rules if either operand has record 3937 // type. The spec says to do this if either type is *overloadable*, 3938 // but enum types can't declare subscript operators or conversion 3939 // operators, so there's nothing interesting for overload resolution 3940 // to do if there aren't any record types involved. 3941 // 3942 // ObjC pointers have their own subscripting logic that is not tied 3943 // to overload resolution and so should not take this path. 3944 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3945 (base->getType()->isRecordType() || 3946 (!base->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 3947 idx->getType()->isRecordType()))) { 3948 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(lbLoc, rbLoc, base, idx); 3949 } 3950 3951 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, rbLoc); 3952 } 3953 3954 ExprResult 3955 Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc, 3956 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) { 3957 Expr *LHSExp = Base; 3958 Expr *RHSExp = Idx; 3959 3960 // Perform default conversions. 3961 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) { 3962 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp); 3963 if (Result.isInvalid()) 3964 return ExprError(); 3965 LHSExp = Result.get(); 3966 } 3967 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp); 3968 if (Result.isInvalid()) 3969 return ExprError(); 3970 RHSExp = Result.get(); 3971 3972 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 3973 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue; 3974 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 3975 3976 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent 3977 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be 3978 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base 3979 // and index from the expression types. 3980 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr; 3981 QualType ResultType; 3982 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) { 3983 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 3984 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3985 ResultType = Context.DependentTy; 3986 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3987 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 3988 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3989 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 3990 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 3991 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3992 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 3993 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3994 3995 // Use custom logic if this should be the pseudo-object subscript 3996 // expression. 3997 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) 3998 return BuildObjCSubscriptExpression(RLoc, BaseExpr, IndexExpr, nullptr, 3999 nullptr); 4000 4001 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4002 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4003 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 4004 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4005 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4006 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4007 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 4008 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 4009 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 4010 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4011 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4012 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4013 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) { 4014 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface) 4015 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4016 return ExprError(); 4017 } 4018 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4019 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123] 4020 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4021 VK = LHSExp->getValueKind(); 4022 if (VK != VK_RValue) 4023 OK = OK_VectorComponent; 4024 4025 // FIXME: need to deal with const... 4026 ResultType = VTy->getElementType(); 4027 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) { 4028 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by 4029 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that 4030 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't 4031 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then 4032 // force the promotion here. 4033 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) << 4034 LHSExp->getSourceRange(); 4035 LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy), 4036 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 4037 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(); 4038 4039 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4040 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4041 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 4042 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) { 4043 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case 4044 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) << 4045 RHSExp->getSourceRange(); 4046 RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy), 4047 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 4048 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 4049 4050 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4051 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4052 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 4053 } else { 4054 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value) 4055 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange()); 4056 } 4057 // C99 6.5.2.1p1 4058 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 4059 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 4060 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange()); 4061 4062 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 4063 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 4064 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 4065 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange(); 4066 4067 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly, 4068 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object 4069 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance) 4070 // incomplete types are not object types. 4071 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) { 4072 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type) 4073 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4074 return ExprError(); 4075 } 4076 4077 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4078 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void 4079 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type) 4080 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4081 4082 // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values. 4083 // See IsCForbiddenLValueType. 4084 if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue; 4085 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && 4086 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType, 4087 diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type, BaseExpr)) 4088 return ExprError(); 4089 4090 assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus || 4091 !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType()); 4092 4093 return new (Context) 4094 ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp, ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc); 4095 } 4096 4097 ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, 4098 FunctionDecl *FD, 4099 ParmVarDecl *Param) { 4100 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) { 4101 Diag(CallLoc, 4102 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) << 4103 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName(); 4104 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param], 4105 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here); 4106 return ExprError(); 4107 } 4108 4109 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) { 4110 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg(); 4111 4112 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(*this, PotentiallyEvaluated, 4113 Param); 4114 4115 // Instantiate the expression. 4116 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MutiLevelArgList 4117 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, nullptr, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true); 4118 4119 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, 4120 MutiLevelArgList.getInnermost()); 4121 if (Inst.isInvalid()) 4122 return ExprError(); 4123 4124 ExprResult Result; 4125 { 4126 // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5: 4127 // The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and 4128 // the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the 4129 // default argument expression appears. 4130 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD); 4131 LocalInstantiationScope Local(*this); 4132 Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, MutiLevelArgList); 4133 } 4134 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4135 return ExprError(); 4136 4137 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter. 4138 InitializedEntity Entity 4139 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param); 4140 InitializationKind Kind 4141 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(), 4142 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getLocStart()); 4143 Expr *ResultE = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 4144 4145 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4146 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4147 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4148 return ExprError(); 4149 4150 Expr *Arg = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 4151 CheckCompletedExpr(Arg, Param->getOuterLocStart()); 4152 // Build the default argument expression. 4153 return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param, Arg); 4154 } 4155 4156 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to 4157 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll 4158 // be properly destroyed. 4159 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new 4160 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810. 4161 // We don't need to do that with block decls, though, because 4162 // blocks in default argument expression can never capture anything. 4163 if (isa<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())) { 4164 // Set the "needs cleanups" bit regardless of whether there are 4165 // any explicit objects. 4166 ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 4167 4168 // Append all the objects to the cleanup list. Right now, this 4169 // should always be a no-op, because blocks in default argument 4170 // expressions should never be able to capture anything. 4171 assert(!cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())->getNumObjects() && 4172 "default argument expression has capturing blocks?"); 4173 } 4174 4175 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works. 4176 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression 4177 // as being "referenced". 4178 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg(), 4179 /*SkipLocalVariables=*/true); 4180 return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param); 4181 } 4182 4183 4184 Sema::VariadicCallType 4185 Sema::getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4186 Expr *Fn) { 4187 if (Proto && Proto->isVariadic()) { 4188 if (dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(FDecl)) 4189 return VariadicConstructor; 4190 else if (Fn && Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) 4191 return VariadicBlock; 4192 else if (FDecl) { 4193 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 4194 if (Method->isInstance()) 4195 return VariadicMethod; 4196 } else if (Fn && Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) 4197 return VariadicMethod; 4198 return VariadicFunction; 4199 } 4200 return VariadicDoesNotApply; 4201 } 4202 4203 namespace { 4204 class FunctionCallCCC : public FunctionCallFilterCCC { 4205 public: 4206 FunctionCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, const IdentifierInfo *FuncName, 4207 unsigned NumArgs, MemberExpr *ME) 4208 : FunctionCallFilterCCC(SemaRef, NumArgs, false, ME), 4209 FunctionName(FuncName) {} 4210 4211 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 4212 if (!candidate.getCorrectionSpecifier() || 4213 candidate.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo() != FunctionName) { 4214 return false; 4215 } 4216 4217 return FunctionCallFilterCCC::ValidateCandidate(candidate); 4218 } 4219 4220 private: 4221 const IdentifierInfo *const FunctionName; 4222 }; 4223 } 4224 4225 static TypoCorrection TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema &S, Expr *Fn, 4226 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4227 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 4228 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn); 4229 DeclarationName FuncName = FDecl->getDeclName(); 4230 SourceLocation NameLoc = ME ? ME->getMemberLoc() : Fn->getLocStart(); 4231 4232 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = S.CorrectTypo( 4233 DeclarationNameInfo(FuncName, NameLoc), Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 4234 S.getScopeForContext(S.CurContext), nullptr, 4235 llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallCCC>(S, FuncName.getAsIdentifierInfo(), 4236 Args.size(), ME), 4237 Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 4238 if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()) { 4239 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 4240 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(NameLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 4241 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4242 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(), 4243 CDEnd = Corrected.end(); 4244 CD != CDEnd; ++CD) { 4245 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD)) 4246 S.AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), Args, 4247 OCS); 4248 } 4249 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, NameLoc, Best)) { 4250 case OR_Success: 4251 ND = Best->Function; 4252 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 4253 break; 4254 default: 4255 break; 4256 } 4257 } 4258 if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) { 4259 return Corrected; 4260 } 4261 } 4262 } 4263 return TypoCorrection(); 4264 } 4265 4266 /// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in 4267 /// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with 4268 /// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and 4269 /// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this 4270 /// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns 4271 /// true if the call is ill-formed. 4272 bool 4273 Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn, 4274 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4275 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4276 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 4277 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 4278 bool IsExecConfig) { 4279 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking. 4280 // We don't need to do this in the 4281 if (FDecl) 4282 if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID()) 4283 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID)) 4284 return false; 4285 4286 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by 4287 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ... 4288 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 4289 bool Invalid = false; 4290 unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumParams; 4291 unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType() 4292 ? 1 /* block */ 4293 : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */ 4294 : 0 /* function */); 4295 4296 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default 4297 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call. 4298 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 4299 if (Args.size() < MinArgs) { 4300 TypoCorrection TC; 4301 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 4302 unsigned diag_id = 4303 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4304 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_suggest 4305 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_suggest; 4306 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << MinArgs 4307 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4308 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 4309 } else if (MinArgs == 1 && FDecl && FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 4310 Diag(RParenLoc, 4311 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4312 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_one 4313 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_one) 4314 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) << Fn->getSourceRange(); 4315 else 4316 Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4317 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args 4318 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least) 4319 << FnKind << MinArgs << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4320 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 4321 4322 // Emit the location of the prototype. 4323 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 4324 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl) 4325 << FDecl; 4326 4327 return true; 4328 } 4329 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams); 4330 } 4331 4332 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop 4333 // them. 4334 if (Args.size() > NumParams) { 4335 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) { 4336 TypoCorrection TC; 4337 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 4338 unsigned diag_id = 4339 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4340 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_suggest 4341 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_suggest; 4342 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << NumParams 4343 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4344 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 4345 } else if (NumParams == 1 && FDecl && 4346 FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 4347 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4348 MinArgs == NumParams 4349 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_one 4350 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_one) 4351 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) 4352 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) << Fn->getSourceRange() 4353 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4354 Args.back()->getLocEnd()); 4355 else 4356 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4357 MinArgs == NumParams 4358 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args 4359 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most) 4360 << FnKind << NumParams << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4361 << Fn->getSourceRange() 4362 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4363 Args.back()->getLocEnd()); 4364 4365 // Emit the location of the prototype. 4366 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 4367 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl) 4368 << FDecl; 4369 4370 // This deletes the extra arguments. 4371 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams); 4372 return true; 4373 } 4374 } 4375 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs; 4376 VariadicCallType CallType = getVariadicCallType(FDecl, Proto, Fn); 4377 4378 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getLocStart(), FDecl, 4379 Proto, 0, Args, AllArgs, CallType); 4380 if (Invalid) 4381 return true; 4382 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size(); 4383 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i) 4384 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]); 4385 4386 return false; 4387 } 4388 4389 bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4390 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4391 unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 4392 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &AllArgs, 4393 VariadicCallType CallType, bool AllowExplicit, 4394 bool IsListInitialization) { 4395 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 4396 bool Invalid = false; 4397 unsigned ArgIx = 0; 4398 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args). 4399 for (unsigned i = FirstParam; i < NumParams; i++) { 4400 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getParamType(i); 4401 4402 Expr *Arg; 4403 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl ? FDecl->getParamDecl(i) : nullptr; 4404 if (ArgIx < Args.size()) { 4405 Arg = Args[ArgIx++]; 4406 4407 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(), 4408 ProtoArgType, 4409 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 4410 return true; 4411 4412 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 4413 bool CFAudited = false; 4414 if (Arg->getType() == Context.ARCUnbridgedCastTy && 4415 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 4416 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 4417 Arg = stripARCUnbridgedCast(Arg); 4418 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 4419 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 4420 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 4421 CFAudited = true; 4422 4423 InitializedEntity Entity = 4424 Param ? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param, 4425 ProtoArgType) 4426 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 4427 Context, ProtoArgType, Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 4428 4429 // Remember that parameter belongs to a CF audited API. 4430 if (CFAudited) 4431 Entity.setParameterCFAudited(); 4432 4433 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization( 4434 Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg, IsListInitialization, AllowExplicit); 4435 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 4436 return true; 4437 4438 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 4439 } else { 4440 assert(Param && "can't use default arguments without a known callee"); 4441 4442 ExprResult ArgExpr = 4443 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param); 4444 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid()) 4445 return true; 4446 4447 Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>(); 4448 } 4449 4450 // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This 4451 // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr 4452 // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator. 4453 CheckArrayAccess(Arg); 4454 4455 // Check for violations of C99 static array rules (C99 6.7.5.3p7). 4456 CheckStaticArrayArgument(CallLoc, Param, Arg); 4457 4458 AllArgs.push_back(Arg); 4459 } 4460 4461 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 4462 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) { 4463 // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that 4464 // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic. 4465 if (Proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && FDecl && 4466 FDecl->isExternC()) { 4467 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) { 4468 QualType paramType; // ignored 4469 ExprResult arg = checkUnknownAnyArg(CallLoc, Args[i], paramType); 4470 Invalid |= arg.isInvalid(); 4471 AllArgs.push_back(arg.get()); 4472 } 4473 4474 // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 4475 } else { 4476 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) { 4477 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], CallType, 4478 FDecl); 4479 Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid(); 4480 AllArgs.push_back(Arg.get()); 4481 } 4482 } 4483 4484 // Check for array bounds violations. 4485 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) 4486 CheckArrayAccess(Args[i]); 4487 } 4488 return Invalid; 4489 } 4490 4491 static void DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema &S, ParmVarDecl *PVD) { 4492 TypeLoc TL = PVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 4493 if (DecayedTypeLoc DTL = TL.getAs<DecayedTypeLoc>()) 4494 TL = DTL.getOriginalLoc(); 4495 if (ArrayTypeLoc ATL = TL.getAs<ArrayTypeLoc>()) 4496 S.Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_static_array) 4497 << ATL.getLocalSourceRange(); 4498 } 4499 4500 /// CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static 4501 /// array parameter, check that it is non-null, and that if it is formed by 4502 /// array-to-pointer decay, the underlying array is sufficiently large. 4503 /// 4504 /// C99 6.7.5.3p7: If the keyword static also appears within the [ and ] of the 4505 /// array type derivation, then for each call to the function, the value of the 4506 /// corresponding actual argument shall provide access to the first element of 4507 /// an array with at least as many elements as specified by the size expression. 4508 void 4509 Sema::CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc, 4510 ParmVarDecl *Param, 4511 const Expr *ArgExpr) { 4512 // Static array parameters are not supported in C++. 4513 if (!Param || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4514 return; 4515 4516 QualType OrigTy = Param->getOriginalType(); 4517 4518 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy); 4519 if (!AT || AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Static) 4520 return; 4521 4522 if (ArgExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 4523 Expr::NPC_NeverValueDependent)) { 4524 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_null_arg) << ArgExpr->getSourceRange(); 4525 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 4526 return; 4527 } 4528 4529 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT); 4530 if (!CAT) 4531 return; 4532 4533 const ConstantArrayType *ArgCAT = 4534 Context.getAsConstantArrayType(ArgExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()); 4535 if (!ArgCAT) 4536 return; 4537 4538 if (ArgCAT->getSize().ult(CAT->getSize())) { 4539 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small) 4540 << ArgExpr->getSourceRange() 4541 << (unsigned) ArgCAT->getSize().getZExtValue() 4542 << (unsigned) CAT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 4543 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 4544 } 4545 } 4546 4547 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 4548 /// to have a function type. 4549 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn); 4550 4551 /// Is the given type a placeholder that we need to lower out 4552 /// immediately during argument processing? 4553 static bool isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type) { 4554 // Placeholders are never sugared. 4555 const BuiltinType *placeholder = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(type); 4556 if (!placeholder) return false; 4557 4558 switch (placeholder->getKind()) { 4559 // Ignore all the non-placeholder types. 4560 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) 4561 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) case BuiltinType::ID: 4562 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 4563 return false; 4564 4565 // We cannot lower out overload sets; they might validly be resolved 4566 // by the call machinery. 4567 case BuiltinType::Overload: 4568 return false; 4569 4570 // Unbridged casts in ARC can be handled in some call positions and 4571 // should be left in place. 4572 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: 4573 return false; 4574 4575 // Pseudo-objects should be converted as soon as possible. 4576 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 4577 return true; 4578 4579 // The debugger mode could theoretically but currently does not try 4580 // to resolve unknown-typed arguments based on known parameter types. 4581 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 4582 return true; 4583 4584 // These are always invalid as call arguments and should be reported. 4585 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: 4586 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: 4587 return true; 4588 } 4589 llvm_unreachable("bad builtin type kind"); 4590 } 4591 4592 /// Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to 4593 /// handle later. 4594 static bool checkArgsForPlaceholders(Sema &S, MultiExprArg args) { 4595 // Apply this processing to all the arguments at once instead of 4596 // dying at the first failure. 4597 bool hasInvalid = false; 4598 for (size_t i = 0, e = args.size(); i != e; i++) { 4599 if (isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(args[i]->getType())) { 4600 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(args[i]); 4601 if (result.isInvalid()) hasInvalid = true; 4602 else args[i] = result.get(); 4603 } else if (hasInvalid) { 4604 (void)S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(args[i]); 4605 } 4606 } 4607 return hasInvalid; 4608 } 4609 4610 /// If a builtin function has a pointer argument with no explicit address 4611 /// space, than it should be able to accept a pointer to any address 4612 /// space as input. In order to do this, we need to replace the 4613 /// standard builtin declaration with one that uses the same address space 4614 /// as the call. 4615 /// 4616 /// \returns nullptr If this builtin is not a candidate for a rewrite i.e. 4617 /// it does not contain any pointer arguments without 4618 /// an address space qualifer. Otherwise the rewritten 4619 /// FunctionDecl is returned. 4620 /// TODO: Handle pointer return types. 4621 static FunctionDecl *rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(Sema *Sema, ASTContext &Context, 4622 const FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4623 MultiExprArg ArgExprs) { 4624 4625 QualType DeclType = FDecl->getType(); 4626 const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(DeclType); 4627 4628 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.hasPtrArgsOrResult(FDecl->getBuiltinID()) || 4629 !FT || FT->isVariadic() || ArgExprs.size() != FT->getNumParams()) 4630 return nullptr; 4631 4632 bool NeedsNewDecl = false; 4633 unsigned i = 0; 4634 SmallVector<QualType, 8> OverloadParams; 4635 4636 for (QualType ParamType : FT->param_types()) { 4637 4638 // Convert array arguments to pointer to simplify type lookup. 4639 Expr *Arg = Sema->DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ArgExprs[i++]).get(); 4640 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType(); 4641 if (!ParamType->isPointerType() || 4642 ParamType.getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace() || 4643 !ArgType->isPointerType() || 4644 !ArgType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace()) { 4645 OverloadParams.push_back(ParamType); 4646 continue; 4647 } 4648 4649 NeedsNewDecl = true; 4650 unsigned AS = ArgType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers().getAddressSpace(); 4651 4652 QualType PointeeType = ParamType->getPointeeType(); 4653 PointeeType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(PointeeType, AS); 4654 OverloadParams.push_back(Context.getPointerType(PointeeType)); 4655 } 4656 4657 if (!NeedsNewDecl) 4658 return nullptr; 4659 4660 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 4661 QualType OverloadTy = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), 4662 OverloadParams, EPI); 4663 DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 4664 FunctionDecl *OverloadDecl = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, 4665 FDecl->getLocation(), 4666 FDecl->getLocation(), 4667 FDecl->getIdentifier(), 4668 OverloadTy, 4669 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 4670 SC_Extern, false, 4671 /*hasPrototype=*/true); 4672 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 4673 FT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OverloadTy); 4674 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 4675 QualType ParamType = FT->getParamType(i); 4676 ParmVarDecl *Parm = 4677 ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, OverloadDecl, SourceLocation(), 4678 SourceLocation(), nullptr, ParamType, 4679 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 4680 Parm->setScopeInfo(0, i); 4681 Params.push_back(Parm); 4682 } 4683 OverloadDecl->setParams(Params); 4684 return OverloadDecl; 4685 } 4686 4687 /// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments. 4688 /// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma 4689 /// locations. 4690 ExprResult 4691 Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 4692 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc, 4693 Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig) { 4694 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 4695 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn); 4696 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4697 Fn = Result.get(); 4698 4699 if (checkArgsForPlaceholders(*this, ArgExprs)) 4700 return ExprError(); 4701 4702 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4703 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately. 4704 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) { 4705 if (!ArgExprs.empty()) { 4706 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments. 4707 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args) 4708 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 4709 SourceRange(ArgExprs[0]->getLocStart(), 4710 ArgExprs.back()->getLocEnd())); 4711 } 4712 4713 return new (Context) 4714 CallExpr(Context, Fn, None, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4715 } 4716 if (Fn->getType() == Context.PseudoObjectTy) { 4717 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Fn); 4718 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4719 Fn = result.get(); 4720 } 4721 4722 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template, 4723 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now. 4724 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in 4725 // Fn. 4726 bool Dependent = false; 4727 if (Fn->isTypeDependent()) 4728 Dependent = true; 4729 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) 4730 Dependent = true; 4731 4732 if (Dependent) { 4733 if (ExecConfig) { 4734 return new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr( 4735 Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), ArgExprs, 4736 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4737 } else { 4738 return new (Context) CallExpr( 4739 Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4740 } 4741 } 4742 4743 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]). 4744 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType()) 4745 return BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 4746 RParenLoc); 4747 4748 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 4749 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 4750 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4751 Fn = result.get(); 4752 } 4753 4754 if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) { 4755 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc); 4756 } 4757 } 4758 4759 // Check for overloaded calls. This can happen even in C due to extensions. 4760 if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) { 4761 OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn); 4762 4763 // We aren't supposed to apply this logic for if there's an '&' involved. 4764 if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer) { 4765 OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression; 4766 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl)) { 4767 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl); 4768 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 4769 RParenLoc, ExecConfig); 4770 } else { 4771 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 4772 RParenLoc); 4773 } 4774 } 4775 } 4776 4777 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration. 4778 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 4779 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 4780 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4781 Fn = result.get(); 4782 } 4783 4784 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens(); 4785 4786 NamedDecl *NDecl = nullptr; 4787 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn)) 4788 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf) 4789 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 4790 4791 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)) { 4792 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl(); 4793 4794 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NDecl); 4795 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID()) { 4796 // Rewrite the function decl for this builtin by replacing paramaters 4797 // with no explicit address space with the address space of the arguments 4798 // in ArgExprs. 4799 if ((FDecl = rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(this, Context, FDecl, ArgExprs))) { 4800 NDecl = FDecl; 4801 Fn = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, FDecl->getQualifierLoc(), 4802 SourceLocation(), FDecl, false, 4803 SourceLocation(), FDecl->getType(), 4804 Fn->getValueKind(), FDecl); 4805 } 4806 } 4807 } else if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) 4808 NDecl = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)->getMemberDecl(); 4809 4810 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl)) { 4811 if (FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>()) { 4812 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(FD, ArgExprs, true)) { 4813 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), 4814 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) ? 4815 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call : 4816 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 4817 << FD << FD->getSourceRange(); 4818 Diag(FD->getLocation(), 4819 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) 4820 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 4821 } 4822 } 4823 } 4824 4825 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, 4826 ExecConfig, IsExecConfig); 4827 } 4828 4829 /// ActOnAsTypeExpr - create a new asType (bitcast) from the arguments. 4830 /// 4831 /// __builtin_astype( value, dst type ) 4832 /// 4833 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 4834 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 4835 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 4836 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 4837 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 4838 QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy); 4839 QualType SrcTy = E->getType(); 4840 if (Context.getTypeSize(DstTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy)) 4841 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, 4842 diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size) 4843 << DstTy 4844 << SrcTy 4845 << E->getSourceRange()); 4846 return new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 4847 } 4848 4849 /// ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the 4850 /// provided arguments. 4851 /// 4852 /// __builtin_convertvector( value, dst type ) 4853 /// 4854 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 4855 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 4856 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 4857 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 4858 GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy, &TInfo); 4859 return SemaConvertVectorExpr(E, TInfo, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 4860 } 4861 4862 /// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression, 4863 /// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should 4864 /// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or 4865 /// block-pointer type. 4866 /// 4867 /// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available 4868 ExprResult 4869 Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl, 4870 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 4871 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 4872 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 4873 Expr *Config, bool IsExecConfig) { 4874 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl); 4875 unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0); 4876 4877 // Promote the function operand. 4878 // We special-case function promotion here because we only allow promoting 4879 // builtin functions to function pointers in the callee of a call. 4880 ExprResult Result; 4881 if (BuiltinID && 4882 Fn->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BuiltinFn)) { 4883 Result = ImpCastExprToType(Fn, Context.getPointerType(FDecl->getType()), 4884 CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get(); 4885 } else { 4886 Result = CallExprUnaryConversions(Fn); 4887 } 4888 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4889 return ExprError(); 4890 Fn = Result.get(); 4891 4892 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup 4893 // of arguments and function on error. 4894 CallExpr *TheCall; 4895 if (Config) 4896 TheCall = new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(Context, Fn, 4897 cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args, 4898 Context.BoolTy, VK_RValue, 4899 RParenLoc); 4900 else 4901 TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, Context.BoolTy, 4902 VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4903 4904 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking. 4905 if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID)) 4906 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall); 4907 4908 retry: 4909 const FunctionType *FuncT; 4910 if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4911 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall 4912 // have type pointer to function". 4913 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 4914 if (!FuncT) 4915 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 4916 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4917 } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT = 4918 Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 4919 FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 4920 } else { 4921 // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type. 4922 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 4923 ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 4924 if (rewrite.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4925 Fn = rewrite.get(); 4926 TheCall->setCallee(Fn); 4927 goto retry; 4928 } 4929 4930 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 4931 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4932 } 4933 4934 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 4935 if (Config) { 4936 // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions 4937 if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 4938 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function) 4939 << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4940 4941 // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type 4942 if (!FuncT->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) 4943 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return) 4944 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4945 } else { 4946 // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured 4947 if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 4948 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config) 4949 << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4950 } 4951 } 4952 4953 // Check for a valid return type 4954 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getReturnType(), Fn->getLocStart(), TheCall, 4955 FDecl)) 4956 return ExprError(); 4957 4958 // We know the result type of the call, set it. 4959 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context)); 4960 TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getReturnType())); 4961 4962 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT); 4963 if (Proto) { 4964 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, RParenLoc, 4965 IsExecConfig)) 4966 return ExprError(); 4967 } else { 4968 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!"); 4969 4970 if (FDecl) { 4971 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based 4972 // on our knowledge of the function definition. 4973 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 4974 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && Args.size() != Def->param_size()) { 4975 Proto = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4976 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && Args.size() >= Def->param_size())) 4977 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments) 4978 << (Args.size() > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange(); 4979 } 4980 4981 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have 4982 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype. 4983 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype()) 4984 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4985 } 4986 4987 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6). 4988 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) { 4989 Expr *Arg = Args[i]; 4990 4991 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumParams()) { 4992 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 4993 Context, Proto->getParamType(i), Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 4994 ExprResult ArgE = 4995 PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg); 4996 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 4997 return true; 4998 4999 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 5000 5001 } else { 5002 ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg); 5003 5004 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 5005 return true; 5006 5007 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 5008 } 5009 5010 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(), 5011 Arg->getType(), 5012 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 5013 return ExprError(); 5014 5015 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg); 5016 } 5017 } 5018 5019 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 5020 if (!Method->isStatic()) 5021 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) 5022 << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5023 5024 // Check for sentinels 5025 if (NDecl) 5026 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args); 5027 5028 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions. 5029 if (FDecl) { 5030 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 5031 return ExprError(); 5032 5033 if (BuiltinID) 5034 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall); 5035 } else if (NDecl) { 5036 if (CheckPointerCall(NDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 5037 return ExprError(); 5038 } else { 5039 if (CheckOtherCall(TheCall, Proto)) 5040 return ExprError(); 5041 } 5042 5043 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 5044 } 5045 5046 ExprResult 5047 Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty, 5048 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) { 5049 assert(Ty && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type"); 5050 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out. 5051 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression"); 5052 5053 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5054 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 5055 if (!TInfo) 5056 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType); 5057 5058 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr); 5059 } 5060 5061 ExprResult 5062 Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 5063 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) { 5064 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType(); 5065 5066 if (literalType->isArrayType()) { 5067 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType), 5068 diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type, 5069 SourceRange(LParenLoc, 5070 LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 5071 return ExprError(); 5072 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType()) 5073 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init) 5074 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())); 5075 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() && 5076 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType, 5077 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type, 5078 SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 5079 return ExprError(); 5080 5081 InitializedEntity Entity 5082 = InitializedEntity::InitializeCompoundLiteralInit(TInfo); 5083 InitializationKind Kind 5084 = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc, 5085 SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), 5086 /*InitList=*/true); 5087 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr); 5088 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr, 5089 &literalType); 5090 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5091 return ExprError(); 5092 LiteralExpr = Result.get(); 5093 5094 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == nullptr; 5095 if (isFileScope && 5096 !LiteralExpr->isTypeDependent() && 5097 !LiteralExpr->isValueDependent() && 5098 !literalType->isDependentType()) { // 6.5.2.5p3 5099 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr, literalType)) 5100 return ExprError(); 5101 } 5102 5103 // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason. 5104 ExprValueKind VK = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue; 5105 5106 return MaybeBindToTemporary( 5107 new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType, 5108 VK, LiteralExpr, isFileScope)); 5109 } 5110 5111 ExprResult 5112 Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList, 5113 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) { 5114 // Immediately handle non-overload placeholders. Overloads can be 5115 // resolved contextually, but everything else here can't. 5116 for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) { 5117 if (InitArgList[I]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 5118 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(InitArgList[I]); 5119 5120 // Ignore failures; dropping the entire initializer list because 5121 // of one failure would be terrible for indexing/etc. 5122 if (result.isInvalid()) continue; 5123 5124 InitArgList[I] = result.get(); 5125 } 5126 } 5127 5128 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and 5129 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized. 5130 5131 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitArgList, 5132 RBraceLoc); 5133 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now. 5134 return E; 5135 } 5136 5137 /// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC. 5138 static void maybeExtendBlockObject(Sema &S, ExprResult &E) { 5139 assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType()); 5140 assert(E.get()->isRValue()); 5141 5142 // Only do this in an r-value context. 5143 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) return; 5144 5145 E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(S.Context, E.get()->getType(), 5146 CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(), 5147 /*base path*/ nullptr, VK_RValue); 5148 S.ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 5149 } 5150 5151 /// Prepare a conversion of the given expression to an ObjC object 5152 /// pointer type. 5153 CastKind Sema::PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E) { 5154 QualType type = E.get()->getType(); 5155 if (type->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 5156 return CK_BitCast; 5157 } else if (type->isBlockPointerType()) { 5158 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, E); 5159 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5160 } else { 5161 assert(type->isPointerType()); 5162 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5163 } 5164 } 5165 5166 /// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages 5167 /// except the final cast and returning the kind required. 5168 CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) { 5169 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer. 5170 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with 5171 // pointers. Everything else should be possible. 5172 5173 QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType(); 5174 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy)) 5175 return CK_NoOp; 5176 5177 switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5178 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5179 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5180 5181 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5182 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5183 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5184 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5185 case Type::STK_CPointer: { 5186 unsigned SrcAS = SrcTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 5187 unsigned DestAS = DestTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 5188 if (SrcAS != DestAS) 5189 return CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 5190 return CK_BitCast; 5191 } 5192 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5193 return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer 5194 ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 5195 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5196 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer) 5197 return CK_BitCast; 5198 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer) 5199 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5200 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, Src); 5201 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5202 case Type::STK_Bool: 5203 return CK_PointerToBoolean; 5204 case Type::STK_Integral: 5205 return CK_PointerToIntegral; 5206 case Type::STK_Floating: 5207 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5208 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5209 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5210 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer"); 5211 } 5212 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5213 5214 case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer 5215 case Type::STK_Integral: 5216 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5217 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5218 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5219 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5220 if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5221 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 5222 return CK_NullToPointer; 5223 return CK_IntegralToPointer; 5224 case Type::STK_Bool: 5225 return CK_IntegralToBoolean; 5226 case Type::STK_Integral: 5227 return CK_IntegralCast; 5228 case Type::STK_Floating: 5229 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 5230 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5231 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5232 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5233 CK_IntegralCast); 5234 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 5235 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5236 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5237 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5238 CK_IntegralToFloating); 5239 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 5240 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5241 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5242 } 5243 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5244 5245 case Type::STK_Floating: 5246 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5247 case Type::STK_Floating: 5248 return CK_FloatingCast; 5249 case Type::STK_Bool: 5250 return CK_FloatingToBoolean; 5251 case Type::STK_Integral: 5252 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 5253 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5254 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5255 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5256 CK_FloatingCast); 5257 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 5258 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5259 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5260 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5261 CK_FloatingToIntegral); 5262 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 5263 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5264 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5265 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5266 llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?"); 5267 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5268 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5269 } 5270 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5271 5272 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5273 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5274 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5275 return CK_FloatingComplexCast; 5276 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5277 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex; 5278 case Type::STK_Floating: { 5279 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 5280 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 5281 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal; 5282 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 5283 return CK_FloatingCast; 5284 } 5285 case Type::STK_Bool: 5286 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean; 5287 case Type::STK_Integral: 5288 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5289 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5290 CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 5291 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 5292 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5293 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5294 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5295 llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?"); 5296 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5297 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5298 } 5299 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5300 5301 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5302 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5303 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5304 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex; 5305 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5306 return CK_IntegralComplexCast; 5307 case Type::STK_Integral: { 5308 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 5309 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 5310 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal; 5311 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 5312 return CK_IntegralCast; 5313 } 5314 case Type::STK_Bool: 5315 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean; 5316 case Type::STK_Floating: 5317 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5318 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5319 CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 5320 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 5321 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5322 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5323 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5324 llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?"); 5325 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5326 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5327 } 5328 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5329 } 5330 5331 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast"); 5332 } 5333 5334 static bool breakDownVectorType(QualType type, uint64_t &len, 5335 QualType &eltType) { 5336 // Vectors are simple. 5337 if (const VectorType *vecType = type->getAs<VectorType>()) { 5338 len = vecType->getNumElements(); 5339 eltType = vecType->getElementType(); 5340 assert(eltType->isScalarType()); 5341 return true; 5342 } 5343 5344 // We allow lax conversion to and from non-vector types, but only if 5345 // they're real types (i.e. non-complex, non-pointer scalar types). 5346 if (!type->isRealType()) return false; 5347 5348 len = 1; 5349 eltType = type; 5350 return true; 5351 } 5352 5353 static bool VectorTypesMatch(Sema &S, QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 5354 uint64_t srcLen, destLen; 5355 QualType srcElt, destElt; 5356 if (!breakDownVectorType(srcTy, srcLen, srcElt)) return false; 5357 if (!breakDownVectorType(destTy, destLen, destElt)) return false; 5358 5359 // ASTContext::getTypeSize will return the size rounded up to a 5360 // power of 2, so instead of using that, we need to use the raw 5361 // element size multiplied by the element count. 5362 uint64_t srcEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(srcElt); 5363 uint64_t destEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(destElt); 5364 5365 return (srcLen * srcEltSize == destLen * destEltSize); 5366 } 5367 5368 /// Is this a legal conversion between two known vector types? 5369 bool Sema::isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 5370 assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType()); 5371 5372 if (!Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions) 5373 return false; 5374 return VectorTypesMatch(*this, srcTy, destTy); 5375 } 5376 5377 bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty, 5378 CastKind &Kind) { 5379 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!"); 5380 5381 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) { 5382 if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, Ty, VectorTy)) 5383 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 5384 Ty->isVectorType() ? 5385 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors : 5386 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer) 5387 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 5388 } else 5389 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 5390 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 5391 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 5392 5393 Kind = CK_BitCast; 5394 return false; 5395 } 5396 5397 ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, 5398 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) { 5399 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!"); 5400 5401 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType(); 5402 5403 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to 5404 // an ExtVectorType. 5405 // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed. 5406 // (See OpenCL 6.2). 5407 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) { 5408 if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, SrcTy, DestTy) 5409 || (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 5410 (DestTy.getCanonicalType() != SrcTy.getCanonicalType()))) { 5411 Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors) 5412 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 5413 return ExprError(); 5414 } 5415 Kind = CK_BitCast; 5416 return CastExpr; 5417 } 5418 5419 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate 5420 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then 5421 // splat from elt type to vector. 5422 if (SrcTy->isPointerType()) 5423 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 5424 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 5425 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 5426 5427 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 5428 ExprResult CastExprRes = CastExpr; 5429 CastKind CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy); 5430 if (CastExprRes.isInvalid()) 5431 return ExprError(); 5432 CastExpr = ImpCastExprToType(CastExprRes.get(), DestElemTy, CK).get(); 5433 5434 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 5435 return CastExpr; 5436 } 5437 5438 ExprResult 5439 Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5440 Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty, 5441 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) { 5442 assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != nullptr) && 5443 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr"); 5444 5445 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType()); 5446 if (D.isInvalidType()) 5447 return ExprError(); 5448 5449 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5450 // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only). 5451 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 5452 } else { 5453 // Make sure any TypoExprs have been dealt with. 5454 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CastExpr); 5455 if (!Res.isUsable()) 5456 return ExprError(); 5457 CastExpr = Res.get(); 5458 } 5459 5460 checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D); 5461 5462 QualType castType = castTInfo->getType(); 5463 Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo); 5464 5465 bool isVectorLiteral = false; 5466 5467 // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal, 5468 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants. 5469 ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr); 5470 ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr); 5471 if ((getLangOpts().AltiVec || getLangOpts().OpenCL) 5472 && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) { 5473 if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) { 5474 Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer); 5475 return ExprError(); 5476 } 5477 if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) { 5478 Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0)); 5479 if (!E->getType()->isVectorType()) 5480 isVectorLiteral = true; 5481 } 5482 else 5483 isVectorLiteral = true; 5484 } 5485 5486 // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')' 5487 // then handle it as such. 5488 if (isVectorLiteral) 5489 return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo); 5490 5491 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially. 5492 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a 5493 // sequence of BinOp comma operators. 5494 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) { 5495 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr); 5496 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5497 CastExpr = Result.get(); 5498 } 5499 5500 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !castType->isVoidType() && 5501 !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(LParenLoc)) 5502 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_old_style_cast) << CastExpr->getSourceRange(); 5503 5504 CheckTollFreeBridgeCast(castType, CastExpr); 5505 5506 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedCast(castType, CastExpr); 5507 5508 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr); 5509 } 5510 5511 ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5512 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E, 5513 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 5514 assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) && 5515 "Expected paren or paren list expression"); 5516 5517 Expr **exprs; 5518 unsigned numExprs; 5519 Expr *subExpr; 5520 SourceLocation LiteralLParenLoc, LiteralRParenLoc; 5521 if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) { 5522 LiteralLParenLoc = PE->getLParenLoc(); 5523 LiteralRParenLoc = PE->getRParenLoc(); 5524 exprs = PE->getExprs(); 5525 numExprs = PE->getNumExprs(); 5526 } else { // isa<ParenExpr> by assertion at function entrance 5527 LiteralLParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getLParen(); 5528 LiteralRParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getRParen(); 5529 subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr(); 5530 exprs = &subExpr; 5531 numExprs = 1; 5532 } 5533 5534 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType(); 5535 assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type"); 5536 5537 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs; 5538 const VectorType *VTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>(); 5539 unsigned numElems = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getNumElements(); 5540 5541 // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of 5542 // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector. 5543 // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be 5544 // replicated to all the components of the vector 5545 if (VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) { 5546 // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the 5547 // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will 5548 // be replicated to all the components of the vector 5549 if (numExprs == 1) { 5550 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 5551 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 5552 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 5553 return ExprError(); 5554 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 5555 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 5556 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 5557 } 5558 else if (numExprs < numElems) { 5559 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), 5560 diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers); 5561 return ExprError(); 5562 } 5563 else 5564 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 5565 } 5566 else { 5567 // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value, 5568 // it will be replicated to all components of the vector. 5569 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 5570 VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector && 5571 numExprs == 1) { 5572 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 5573 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 5574 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 5575 return ExprError(); 5576 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 5577 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 5578 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 5579 } 5580 5581 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 5582 } 5583 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly 5584 // braces instead of the original commas. 5585 InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LiteralLParenLoc, 5586 initExprs, LiteralRParenLoc); 5587 initE->setType(Ty); 5588 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE); 5589 } 5590 5591 /// This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn 5592 /// the ParenListExpr into a sequence of comma binary operators. 5593 ExprResult 5594 Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) { 5595 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr); 5596 if (!E) 5597 return OrigExpr; 5598 5599 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0)); 5600 5601 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i) 5602 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(), 5603 E->getExpr(i)); 5604 5605 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5606 5607 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get()); 5608 } 5609 5610 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L, 5611 SourceLocation R, 5612 MultiExprArg Val) { 5613 Expr *expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, Val, R); 5614 return expr; 5615 } 5616 5617 /// \brief Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer 5618 /// constant and the other is not a pointer. Returns true if a diagnostic is 5619 /// emitted. 5620 bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 5621 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5622 Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr; 5623 Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr; 5624 Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind = 5625 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5626 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 5627 5628 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) { 5629 NullExpr = RHSExpr; 5630 NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr; 5631 NullKind = 5632 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5633 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 5634 } 5635 5636 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) 5637 return false; 5638 5639 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) 5640 return false; 5641 5642 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroLiteral) { 5643 // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL" 5644 // string in the source code. 5645 NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 5646 SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc(); 5647 if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL")) 5648 return false; 5649 } 5650 5651 int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX11_nullptr); 5652 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null) 5653 << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType 5654 << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 5655 return true; 5656 } 5657 5658 /// \brief Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise. 5659 static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5660 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType(); 5661 5662 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i says the condition cannot be a floating point type. 5663 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isFloatingType()) { 5664 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat) 5665 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange(); 5666 return true; 5667 } 5668 5669 // C99 6.5.15p2 5670 if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false; 5671 5672 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar) 5673 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange(); 5674 return true; 5675 } 5676 5677 /// \brief Handle when one or both operands are void type. 5678 static QualType checkConditionalVoidType(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5679 ExprResult &RHS) { 5680 Expr *LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 5681 Expr *RHSExpr = RHS.get(); 5682 5683 if (!LHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 5684 S.Diag(RHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 5685 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 5686 if (!RHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 5687 S.Diag(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 5688 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 5689 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 5690 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 5691 return S.Context.VoidTy; 5692 } 5693 5694 /// \brief Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy, 5695 /// true otherwise. 5696 static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr, 5697 QualType PointerTy) { 5698 if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) || 5699 !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 5700 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 5701 return true; 5702 5703 NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.get(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer); 5704 return false; 5705 } 5706 5707 /// \brief Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting 5708 /// type. 5709 static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5710 ExprResult &RHS, 5711 SourceLocation Loc) { 5712 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5713 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5714 5715 if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) { 5716 // Two identical pointers types are always compatible. 5717 return LHSTy; 5718 } 5719 5720 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 5721 5722 // Get the pointee types. 5723 bool IsBlockPointer = false; 5724 if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 5725 lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType(); 5726 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5727 IsBlockPointer = true; 5728 } else { 5729 lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5730 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5731 } 5732 5733 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types or to 5734 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is 5735 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the composite 5736 // type. 5737 5738 // Only CVR-qualifiers exist in the standard, and the differently-qualified 5739 // clause doesn't make sense for our extensions. E.g. address space 2 should 5740 // be incompatible with address space 3: they may live on different devices or 5741 // anything. 5742 Qualifiers lhQual = lhptee.getQualifiers(); 5743 Qualifiers rhQual = rhptee.getQualifiers(); 5744 5745 unsigned MergedCVRQual = lhQual.getCVRQualifiers() | rhQual.getCVRQualifiers(); 5746 lhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 5747 rhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 5748 5749 lhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), lhQual); 5750 rhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), rhQual); 5751 5752 QualType CompositeTy = S.Context.mergeTypes(lhptee, rhptee); 5753 5754 if (CompositeTy.isNull()) { 5755 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers) 5756 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 5757 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5758 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good 5759 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick 5760 // to get a consistent AST. 5761 QualType incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy); 5762 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 5763 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 5764 return incompatTy; 5765 } 5766 5767 // The pointer types are compatible. 5768 QualType ResultTy = CompositeTy.withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual); 5769 if (IsBlockPointer) 5770 ResultTy = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(ResultTy); 5771 else 5772 ResultTy = S.Context.getPointerType(ResultTy); 5773 5774 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast); 5775 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast); 5776 return ResultTy; 5777 } 5778 5779 /// \brief Returns true if QT is quelified-id and implements 'NSObject' and/or 5780 /// 'NSCopying' protocols (and nothing else); or QT is an NSObject and optionally 5781 /// implements 'NSObject' and/or NSCopying' protocols (and nothing else). 5782 static bool isObjCPtrBlockCompatible(Sema &S, ASTContext &C, QualType QT) { 5783 if (QT->isObjCIdType()) 5784 return true; 5785 5786 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 5787 if (!OPT) 5788 return false; 5789 5790 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) 5791 if (ID->getIdentifier() != &C.Idents.get("NSObject")) 5792 return false; 5793 5794 ObjCProtocolDecl* PNSCopying = 5795 S.LookupProtocol(&C.Idents.get("NSCopying"), SourceLocation()); 5796 ObjCProtocolDecl* PNSObject = 5797 S.LookupProtocol(&C.Idents.get("NSObject"), SourceLocation()); 5798 5799 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) { 5800 if ((PNSCopying && declaresSameEntity(Proto, PNSCopying)) || 5801 (PNSObject && declaresSameEntity(Proto, PNSObject))) 5802 ; 5803 else 5804 return false; 5805 } 5806 return true; 5807 } 5808 5809 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers. 5810 static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, 5811 ExprResult &LHS, 5812 ExprResult &RHS, 5813 SourceLocation Loc) { 5814 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5815 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5816 5817 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) { 5818 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 5819 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy); 5820 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5821 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5822 return destType; 5823 } 5824 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 5825 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 5826 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5827 return QualType(); 5828 } 5829 5830 // We have 2 block pointer types. 5831 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 5832 } 5833 5834 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers. 5835 static QualType 5836 checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5837 ExprResult &RHS, 5838 SourceLocation Loc) { 5839 // get the pointer types 5840 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5841 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5842 5843 // get the "pointed to" types 5844 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5845 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5846 5847 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6) 5848 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 5849 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6) 5850 QualType destPointee 5851 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 5852 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 5853 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 5854 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 5855 // Promote to void*. 5856 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5857 return destType; 5858 } 5859 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 5860 QualType destPointee 5861 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 5862 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 5863 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 5864 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 5865 // Promote to void*. 5866 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5867 return destType; 5868 } 5869 5870 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 5871 } 5872 5873 /// \brief Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second 5874 /// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise. 5875 static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int, 5876 Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc, 5877 bool IsIntFirstExpr) { 5878 if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() || 5879 !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) 5880 return false; 5881 5882 Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr; 5883 Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get(); 5884 5885 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch) 5886 << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType() 5887 << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange(); 5888 Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.get(), PointerExpr->getType(), 5889 CK_IntegralToPointer); 5890 return true; 5891 } 5892 5893 /// \brief Simple conversion between integer and floating point types. 5894 /// 5895 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the 5896 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar. 5897 /// 5898 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i and s6.11.6 together require that the scalar 5899 /// types are either integer or floating type. Between the two 5900 /// operands, the type with the higher rank is defined as the "result 5901 /// type". The other operand needs to be promoted to the same type. No 5902 /// other type promotion is allowed. We cannot use 5903 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() for this purpose, since it always 5904 /// promotes promotable types. 5905 static QualType OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5906 ExprResult &RHS, 5907 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5908 LHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 5909 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 5910 return QualType(); 5911 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 5912 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 5913 return QualType(); 5914 5915 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 5916 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 5917 QualType LHSType = 5918 S.Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 5919 QualType RHSType = 5920 S.Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 5921 5922 if (!LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSType->isRealFloatingType()) { 5923 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float) 5924 << LHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5925 return QualType(); 5926 } 5927 5928 if (!RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) { 5929 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float) 5930 << RHSType << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5931 return QualType(); 5932 } 5933 5934 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 5935 if (LHSType == RHSType) 5936 return LHSType; 5937 5938 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double). 5939 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) 5940 return handleFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 5941 /*IsCompAssign = */ false); 5942 5943 // Finally, we have two differing integer types. 5944 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 5945 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*IsCompAssign = */ false); 5946 } 5947 5948 /// \brief Convert scalar operands to a vector that matches the 5949 /// condition in length. 5950 /// 5951 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the 5952 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar. 5953 /// 5954 /// We first compute the "result type" for the scalar operands 5955 /// according to OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. Both operands are then converted 5956 /// into a vector of that type where the length matches the condition 5957 /// vector type. s6.11.6 requires that the element types of the result 5958 /// and the condition must have the same number of bits. 5959 static QualType 5960 OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 5961 QualType CondTy, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5962 QualType ResTy = OpenCLArithmeticConversions(S, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc); 5963 if (ResTy.isNull()) return QualType(); 5964 5965 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 5966 assert(CV); 5967 5968 // Determine the vector result type 5969 unsigned NumElements = CV->getNumElements(); 5970 QualType VectorTy = S.Context.getExtVectorType(ResTy, NumElements); 5971 5972 // Ensure that all types have the same number of bits 5973 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CV->getElementType()) 5974 != S.Context.getTypeSize(ResTy)) { 5975 // Since VectorTy is created internally, it does not pretty print 5976 // with an OpenCL name. Instead, we just print a description. 5977 std::string EleTyName = ResTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString(); 5978 SmallString<64> Str; 5979 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str); 5980 OS << "(vector of " << NumElements << " '" << EleTyName << "' values)"; 5981 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size) 5982 << CondTy << OS.str(); 5983 return QualType(); 5984 } 5985 5986 // Convert operands to the vector result type 5987 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 5988 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 5989 5990 return VectorTy; 5991 } 5992 5993 /// \brief Return false if this is a valid OpenCL condition vector 5994 static bool checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, 5995 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5996 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 says the elements of the vector must be of 5997 // integral type. 5998 const VectorType *CondTy = Cond->getType()->getAs<VectorType>(); 5999 assert(CondTy); 6000 QualType EleTy = CondTy->getElementType(); 6001 if (EleTy->isIntegerType()) return false; 6002 6003 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat) 6004 << Cond->getType() << Cond->getSourceRange(); 6005 return true; 6006 } 6007 6008 /// \brief Return false if the vector condition type and the vector 6009 /// result type are compatible. 6010 /// 6011 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 requires that both vector types have the same 6012 /// number of elements, and their element types have the same number 6013 /// of bits. 6014 static bool checkVectorResult(Sema &S, QualType CondTy, QualType VecResTy, 6015 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6016 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 6017 const VectorType *RV = VecResTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 6018 assert(CV && RV); 6019 6020 if (CV->getNumElements() != RV->getNumElements()) { 6021 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_size) 6022 << CondTy << VecResTy; 6023 return true; 6024 } 6025 6026 QualType CVE = CV->getElementType(); 6027 QualType RVE = RV->getElementType(); 6028 6029 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CVE) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RVE)) { 6030 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size) 6031 << CondTy << VecResTy; 6032 return true; 6033 } 6034 6035 return false; 6036 } 6037 6038 /// \brief Return the resulting type for the conditional operator in 6039 /// OpenCL (aka "ternary selection operator", OpenCL v1.1 6040 /// s6.3.i) when the condition is a vector type. 6041 static QualType 6042 OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema &S, ExprResult &Cond, 6043 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 6044 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6045 Cond = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Cond.get()); 6046 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 6047 return QualType(); 6048 QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType(); 6049 6050 if (checkOpenCLConditionVector(S, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc)) 6051 return QualType(); 6052 6053 // If either operand is a vector then find the vector type of the 6054 // result as specified in OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. 6055 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 6056 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 6057 QualType VecResTy = S.CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, 6058 /*isCompAssign*/false); 6059 if (VecResTy.isNull()) return QualType(); 6060 // The result type must match the condition type as specified in 6061 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6. 6062 if (checkVectorResult(S, CondTy, VecResTy, QuestionLoc)) 6063 return QualType(); 6064 return VecResTy; 6065 } 6066 6067 // Both operands are scalar. 6068 return OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(S, LHS, RHS, CondTy, QuestionLoc); 6069 } 6070 6071 /// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension. 6072 /// In that case, LHS = cond. 6073 /// C99 6.5.15 6074 QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS, 6075 ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK, 6076 ExprObjectKind &OK, 6077 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6078 6079 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 6080 if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 6081 LHS = LHSResult; 6082 6083 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 6084 if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 6085 RHS = RHSResult; 6086 6087 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker. 6088 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 6089 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 6090 6091 VK = VK_RValue; 6092 OK = OK_Ordinary; 6093 6094 // The OpenCL operator with a vector condition is sufficiently 6095 // different to merit its own checker. 6096 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && Cond.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 6097 return OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(*this, Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc); 6098 6099 // First, check the condition. 6100 Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.get()); 6101 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 6102 return QualType(); 6103 if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc)) 6104 return QualType(); 6105 6106 // Now check the two expressions. 6107 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 6108 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 6109 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/false); 6110 6111 QualType ResTy = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 6112 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 6113 return QualType(); 6114 6115 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6116 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6117 6118 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions 6119 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5. 6120 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) { 6121 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(LHS, ResTy)); 6122 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(RHS, ResTy)); 6123 6124 return ResTy; 6125 } 6126 6127 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that 6128 // type. 6129 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3 6130 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) 6131 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl()) 6132 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has 6133 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped. 6134 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType(); 6135 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode. 6136 } 6137 6138 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type." 6139 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism). 6140 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) { 6141 return checkConditionalVoidType(*this, LHS, RHS); 6142 } 6143 6144 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has 6145 // the type of the other operand." 6146 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy; 6147 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy; 6148 6149 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here. 6150 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS, 6151 QuestionLoc); 6152 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 6153 return QualType(); 6154 if (!compositeType.isNull()) 6155 return compositeType; 6156 6157 6158 // Handle block pointer types. 6159 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) 6160 return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 6161 QuestionLoc); 6162 6163 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6). 6164 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) 6165 return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 6166 QuestionLoc); 6167 6168 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that 6169 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point. 6170 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 6171 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/true)) 6172 return RHSTy; 6173 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 6174 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/false)) 6175 return LHSTy; 6176 6177 // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer 6178 // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most 6179 // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression. 6180 if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc)) 6181 return QualType(); 6182 6183 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible. 6184 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 6185 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6186 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6187 return QualType(); 6188 } 6189 6190 /// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of 6191 /// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions. 6192 QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 6193 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6194 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6195 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6196 6197 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result 6198 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the 6199 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields. 6200 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 6201 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 6202 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6203 return LHSTy; 6204 } 6205 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 6206 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 6207 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6208 return RHSTy; 6209 } 6210 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id 6211 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 6212 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 6213 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6214 return LHSTy; 6215 } 6216 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 6217 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 6218 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6219 return RHSTy; 6220 } 6221 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL 6222 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) && 6223 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 6224 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast); 6225 return LHSTy; 6226 } 6227 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) && 6228 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 6229 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_BitCast); 6230 return RHSTy; 6231 } 6232 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types. 6233 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 6234 6235 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) { 6236 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible. 6237 return LHSTy; 6238 } 6239 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 6240 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 6241 QualType compositeType = LHSTy; 6242 6243 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be 6244 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite 6245 // type. This allows 6246 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b 6247 // where B is a subclass of A. 6248 // 6249 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id' 6250 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are 6251 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite 6252 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to. 6253 6254 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'. 6255 // It could return the composite type. 6256 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) { 6257 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy; 6258 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) { 6259 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy; 6260 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || 6261 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) && 6262 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) { 6263 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly. 6264 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to 6265 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be 6266 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible. 6267 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 6268 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) { 6269 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 6270 } else if (!(compositeType = 6271 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull()) 6272 ; 6273 else { 6274 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 6275 << LHSTy << RHSTy 6276 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6277 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType(); 6278 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 6279 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 6280 return incompatTy; 6281 } 6282 // The object pointer types are compatible. 6283 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 6284 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 6285 return compositeType; 6286 } 6287 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *' 6288 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 6289 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 6290 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 6291 // so these types are not compatible. 6292 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 6293 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6294 LHS = RHS = true; 6295 return QualType(); 6296 } 6297 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6298 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6299 QualType destPointee 6300 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 6301 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 6302 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 6303 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 6304 // Promote to void*. 6305 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6306 return destType; 6307 } 6308 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 6309 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 6310 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 6311 // so these types are not compatible. 6312 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 6313 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6314 LHS = RHS = true; 6315 return QualType(); 6316 } 6317 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6318 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6319 QualType destPointee 6320 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 6321 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 6322 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 6323 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 6324 // Promote to void*. 6325 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6326 return destType; 6327 } 6328 return QualType(); 6329 } 6330 6331 /// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps 6332 /// ParenRange in parentheses. 6333 static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc, 6334 const PartialDiagnostic &Note, 6335 SourceRange ParenRange) { 6336 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd()); 6337 if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() && 6338 EndLoc.isValid()) { 6339 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) 6340 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(") 6341 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")"); 6342 } else { 6343 // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note. 6344 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange; 6345 } 6346 } 6347 6348 static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 6349 return Opc >= BO_Mul && Opc <= BO_Shr; 6350 } 6351 6352 /// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary 6353 /// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator, 6354 /// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side 6355 /// expression. 6356 static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode, 6357 Expr **RHSExprs) { 6358 // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis. 6359 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 6360 E = E->IgnoreConversionOperator(); 6361 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 6362 6363 // Built-in binary operator. 6364 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 6365 if (IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) { 6366 *Opcode = OP->getOpcode(); 6367 *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS(); 6368 return true; 6369 } 6370 } 6371 6372 // Overloaded operator. 6373 if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 6374 if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2) 6375 return false; 6376 6377 // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into 6378 // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op. 6379 OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator(); 6380 if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow || 6381 OO == OO_PlusPlus || OO == OO_MinusMinus) 6382 return false; 6383 6384 BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO); 6385 if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) { 6386 *Opcode = OpKind; 6387 *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1); 6388 return true; 6389 } 6390 } 6391 6392 return false; 6393 } 6394 6395 static bool IsLogicOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 6396 return (Opc >= BO_LT && Opc <= BO_NE) || (Opc >= BO_LAnd && Opc <= BO_LOr); 6397 } 6398 6399 /// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type 6400 /// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is 6401 /// commonly interpreted as boolean. 6402 static bool ExprLooksBoolean(Expr *E) { 6403 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 6404 6405 if (E->getType()->isBooleanType()) 6406 return true; 6407 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 6408 return IsLogicOp(OP->getOpcode()); 6409 if (UnaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) 6410 return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot; 6411 if (E->getType()->isPointerType()) 6412 return true; 6413 6414 return false; 6415 } 6416 6417 /// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator 6418 /// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed 6419 /// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example: 6420 /// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2". 6421 static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self, 6422 SourceLocation OpLoc, 6423 Expr *Condition, 6424 Expr *LHSExpr, 6425 Expr *RHSExpr) { 6426 BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode; 6427 Expr *CondRHS; 6428 6429 if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS)) 6430 return; 6431 if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS)) 6432 return; 6433 6434 // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right- 6435 // hand side that looks boolean, so warn. 6436 6437 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_conditional) 6438 << Condition->getSourceRange() 6439 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode); 6440 6441 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 6442 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 6443 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode), 6444 SourceRange(Condition->getLocStart(), Condition->getLocEnd())); 6445 6446 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 6447 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first), 6448 SourceRange(CondRHS->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd())); 6449 } 6450 6451 /// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null 6452 /// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension. 6453 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc, 6454 SourceLocation ColonLoc, 6455 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr, 6456 Expr *RHSExpr) { 6457 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6458 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes in the condition because it 6459 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 6460 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 6461 ExprResult CondResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CondExpr); 6462 if (!CondResult.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 6463 CondExpr = CondResult.get(); 6464 } 6465 6466 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS 6467 // was the condition. 6468 OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = nullptr; 6469 Expr *commonExpr = nullptr; 6470 if (!LHSExpr) { 6471 commonExpr = CondExpr; 6472 // Lower out placeholder types first. This is important so that we don't 6473 // try to capture a placeholder. This happens in few cases in C++; such 6474 // as Objective-C++'s dictionary subscripting syntax. 6475 if (commonExpr->hasPlaceholderType()) { 6476 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(commonExpr); 6477 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 6478 commonExpr = result.get(); 6479 } 6480 // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except 6481 // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional. 6482 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 6483 && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent() 6484 && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind() 6485 && commonExpr->isGLValue() 6486 && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 6487 && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 6488 && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) { 6489 ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr); 6490 if (commonRes.isInvalid()) 6491 return ExprError(); 6492 commonExpr = commonRes.get(); 6493 } 6494 6495 opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(), 6496 commonExpr->getType(), 6497 commonExpr->getValueKind(), 6498 commonExpr->getObjectKind(), 6499 commonExpr); 6500 LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue; 6501 } 6502 6503 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 6504 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 6505 ExprResult Cond = CondExpr, LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 6506 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, 6507 VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 6508 if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() || 6509 RHS.isInvalid()) 6510 return ExprError(); 6511 6512 DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), 6513 RHS.get()); 6514 6515 if (!commonExpr) 6516 return new (Context) 6517 ConditionalOperator(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc, LHS.get(), ColonLoc, 6518 RHS.get(), result, VK, OK); 6519 6520 return new (Context) BinaryConditionalOperator( 6521 commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 6522 ColonLoc, result, VK, OK); 6523 } 6524 6525 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite 6526 // being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this 6527 // routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee. 6528 // This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3]. 6529 // FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment. 6530 static Sema::AssignConvertType 6531 checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 6532 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 6533 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 6534 6535 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 6536 const Type *lhptee, *rhptee; 6537 Qualifiers lhq, rhq; 6538 std::tie(lhptee, lhq) = 6539 cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 6540 std::tie(rhptee, rhq) = 6541 cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 6542 6543 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 6544 6545 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints 6546 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the 6547 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right; 6548 6549 // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay. 6550 if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() && 6551 lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) { 6552 // Ignore lifetime for further calculation. 6553 lhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 6554 rhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 6555 } 6556 6557 if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq)) { 6558 // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal. TODO: address subspaces 6559 if (!lhq.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhq)) 6560 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6561 6562 // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to 6563 // and from void*. 6564 else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime() 6565 .compatiblyIncludes( 6566 rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime()) 6567 && (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType())) 6568 ; // keep old 6569 6570 // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal. 6571 else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) 6572 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6573 6574 // For GCC compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated 6575 // as still compatible in C. 6576 else ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6577 } 6578 6579 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or 6580 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified 6581 // version of void... 6582 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) { 6583 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 6584 return ConvTy; 6585 6586 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 6587 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType()); 6588 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 6589 } 6590 6591 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) { 6592 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 6593 return ConvTy; 6594 6595 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 6596 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType()); 6597 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 6598 } 6599 6600 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or 6601 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ... 6602 QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0); 6603 if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) { 6604 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign. 6605 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs 6606 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned. 6607 if (lhptee->isCharType()) 6608 ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 6609 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 6610 ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans); 6611 6612 if (rhptee->isCharType()) 6613 rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 6614 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 6615 rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans); 6616 6617 if (ltrans == rtrans) { 6618 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility 6619 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign 6620 // warning can be disabled. 6621 if (ConvTy != Sema::Compatible) 6622 return ConvTy; 6623 6624 return Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign; 6625 } 6626 6627 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply 6628 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If 6629 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same 6630 // level of indirection, this must be the issue. 6631 if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) { 6632 do { 6633 lhptee = cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(); 6634 rhptee = cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(); 6635 } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)); 6636 6637 if (lhptee == rhptee) 6638 return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers; 6639 } 6640 6641 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers. 6642 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6643 } 6644 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6645 S.IsNoReturnConversion(ltrans, rtrans, ltrans)) 6646 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6647 return ConvTy; 6648 } 6649 6650 /// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two 6651 /// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer 6652 /// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer 6653 // types. 6654 static Sema::AssignConvertType 6655 checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 6656 QualType RHSType) { 6657 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 6658 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 6659 6660 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 6661 6662 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 6663 lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType(); 6664 rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType(); 6665 6666 // In C++, the types have to match exactly. 6667 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 6668 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 6669 6670 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 6671 6672 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical. 6673 if (lhptee.getLocalQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalQualifiers()) 6674 ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6675 6676 if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 6677 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 6678 6679 return ConvTy; 6680 } 6681 6682 /// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types 6683 /// for assignment compatibility. 6684 static Sema::AssignConvertType 6685 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 6686 QualType RHSType) { 6687 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!"); 6688 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!"); 6689 6690 if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 6691 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers. 6692 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 6693 !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 6694 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6695 return Sema::Compatible; 6696 } 6697 if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 6698 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 6699 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 6700 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6701 return Sema::Compatible; 6702 } 6703 QualType lhptee = LHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6704 QualType rhptee = RHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6705 6706 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee) && 6707 // make an exception for id<P> 6708 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 6709 return Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6710 6711 if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 6712 return Sema::Compatible; 6713 if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 6714 return Sema::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId; 6715 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6716 } 6717 6718 Sema::AssignConvertType 6719 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc, 6720 QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 6721 // Fake up an opaque expression. We don't actually care about what 6722 // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints 6723 // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't 6724 // usually happen on valid code. 6725 OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_RValue); 6726 ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr; 6727 CastKind K = CK_Invalid; 6728 6729 return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K); 6730 } 6731 6732 /// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently 6733 /// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking 6734 /// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings: 6735 /// 6736 /// int a, *pint; 6737 /// short *pshort; 6738 /// struct foo *pfoo; 6739 /// 6740 /// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 6741 /// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast 6742 /// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast 6743 /// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 6744 /// 6745 /// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the 6746 /// C99 spec dictates. 6747 /// 6748 /// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible. 6749 Sema::AssignConvertType 6750 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS, 6751 CastKind &Kind) { 6752 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 6753 QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType; 6754 6755 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing 6756 // them. 6757 LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 6758 RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 6759 6760 // Common case: no conversion required. 6761 if (LHSType == RHSType) { 6762 Kind = CK_NoOp; 6763 return Compatible; 6764 } 6765 6766 // If we have an atomic type, try a non-atomic assignment, then just add an 6767 // atomic qualification step. 6768 if (const AtomicType *AtomicTy = dyn_cast<AtomicType>(LHSType)) { 6769 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 6770 CheckAssignmentConstraints(AtomicTy->getValueType(), RHS, Kind); 6771 if (result != Compatible) 6772 return result; 6773 if (Kind != CK_NoOp) 6774 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), AtomicTy->getValueType(), Kind); 6775 Kind = CK_NonAtomicToAtomic; 6776 return Compatible; 6777 } 6778 6779 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a 6780 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C, 6781 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case, 6782 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the 6783 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting 6784 // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference 6785 // type. 6786 if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 6787 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) { 6788 Kind = CK_LValueBitCast; 6789 return Compatible; 6790 } 6791 return Incompatible; 6792 } 6793 6794 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type 6795 // to the same ExtVector type. 6796 if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) { 6797 if (RHSType->isExtVectorType()) 6798 return Incompatible; 6799 if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) { 6800 // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the 6801 // element type. 6802 QualType elType = cast<ExtVectorType>(LHSType)->getElementType(); 6803 if (elType != RHSType) { 6804 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, elType); 6805 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), elType, Kind); 6806 } 6807 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 6808 return Compatible; 6809 } 6810 } 6811 6812 // Conversions to or from vector type. 6813 if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) { 6814 if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) { 6815 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC 6816 // vector type and vice versa 6817 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 6818 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6819 return Compatible; 6820 } 6821 6822 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both 6823 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast; 6824 // no bits are changed but the result type is different. 6825 if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 6826 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6827 return IncompatibleVectors; 6828 } 6829 } 6830 return Incompatible; 6831 } 6832 6833 // Arithmetic conversions. 6834 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() && 6835 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) { 6836 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType); 6837 return Compatible; 6838 } 6839 6840 // Conversions to normal pointers. 6841 if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) { 6842 // U* -> T* 6843 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 6844 unsigned AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 6845 unsigned AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 6846 Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast; 6847 return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 6848 } 6849 6850 // int -> T* 6851 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6852 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null? 6853 return IntToPointer; 6854 } 6855 6856 // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 6857 // with two exceptions: 6858 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 6859 // - conversions to void* 6860 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 6861 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6862 return Compatible; 6863 } 6864 6865 // - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type 6866 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && 6867 Context.hasSameType(LHSType, 6868 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 6869 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6870 return Compatible; 6871 } 6872 6873 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6874 return IncompatiblePointer; 6875 } 6876 6877 // U^ -> void* 6878 if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 6879 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 6880 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6881 return Compatible; 6882 } 6883 } 6884 6885 return Incompatible; 6886 } 6887 6888 // Conversions to block pointers. 6889 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) { 6890 // U^ -> T^ 6891 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 6892 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6893 return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 6894 } 6895 6896 // int or null -> T^ 6897 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6898 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 6899 return IntToBlockPointer; 6900 } 6901 6902 // id -> T^ 6903 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) { 6904 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 6905 return Compatible; 6906 } 6907 6908 // void* -> T^ 6909 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>()) 6910 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 6911 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 6912 return Compatible; 6913 } 6914 6915 return Incompatible; 6916 } 6917 6918 // Conversions to Objective-C pointers. 6919 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) { 6920 // A* -> B* 6921 if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 6922 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6923 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 6924 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 6925 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 6926 result == Compatible && 6927 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType)) 6928 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 6929 return result; 6930 } 6931 6932 // int or null -> A* 6933 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6934 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 6935 return IntToPointer; 6936 } 6937 6938 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 6939 // with two exceptions: 6940 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 6941 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6942 6943 // - conversions from 'void*' 6944 if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) { 6945 return Compatible; 6946 } 6947 6948 // - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type 6949 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && 6950 Context.hasSameType(RHSType, 6951 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 6952 return Compatible; 6953 } 6954 6955 return IncompatiblePointer; 6956 } 6957 6958 // Only under strict condition T^ is compatible with an Objective-C pointer. 6959 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 6960 isObjCPtrBlockCompatible(*this, Context, LHSType)) { 6961 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, RHS); 6962 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6963 return Compatible; 6964 } 6965 6966 return Incompatible; 6967 } 6968 6969 // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above. 6970 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 6971 // T* -> _Bool 6972 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 6973 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 6974 return Compatible; 6975 } 6976 6977 // T* -> int 6978 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6979 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 6980 return PointerToInt; 6981 } 6982 6983 return Incompatible; 6984 } 6985 6986 // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above. 6987 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 6988 // T* -> _Bool 6989 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 6990 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 6991 return Compatible; 6992 } 6993 6994 // T* -> int 6995 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6996 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 6997 return PointerToInt; 6998 } 6999 7000 return Incompatible; 7001 } 7002 7003 // struct A -> struct B 7004 if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) { 7005 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 7006 Kind = CK_NoOp; 7007 return Compatible; 7008 } 7009 } 7010 7011 return Incompatible; 7012 } 7013 7014 /// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is 7015 /// used to initialize the transparent union. 7016 static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C, 7017 ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType, 7018 FieldDecl *Field) { 7019 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member 7020 // of the transparent union. 7021 Expr *E = EResult.get(); 7022 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(), 7023 E, SourceLocation()); 7024 Initializer->setType(UnionType); 7025 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field); 7026 7027 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent 7028 // union type from this initializer list. 7029 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType); 7030 EResult = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType, 7031 VK_RValue, Initializer, false); 7032 } 7033 7034 Sema::AssignConvertType 7035 Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, 7036 ExprResult &RHS) { 7037 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 7038 7039 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential 7040 // transparent_union GCC extension. 7041 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType(); 7042 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 7043 return Incompatible; 7044 7045 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 7046 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 7047 FieldDecl *InitField = nullptr; 7048 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 7049 for (auto *it : UD->fields()) { 7050 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) { 7051 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow: 7052 // 1) void pointer 7053 // 2) null pointer constant 7054 if (RHSType->isPointerType()) 7055 if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 7056 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast); 7057 InitField = it; 7058 break; 7059 } 7060 7061 if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 7062 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 7063 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), 7064 CK_NullToPointer); 7065 InitField = it; 7066 break; 7067 } 7068 } 7069 7070 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid; 7071 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind) 7072 == Compatible) { 7073 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), Kind); 7074 InitField = it; 7075 break; 7076 } 7077 } 7078 7079 if (!InitField) 7080 return Incompatible; 7081 7082 ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField); 7083 return Compatible; 7084 } 7085 7086 Sema::AssignConvertType 7087 Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS, 7088 bool Diagnose, 7089 bool DiagnoseCFAudited) { 7090 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7091 if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) { 7092 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the 7093 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the 7094 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand. 7095 ExprResult Res; 7096 if (Diagnose) { 7097 Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 7098 AA_Assigning); 7099 } else { 7100 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 7101 TryImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 7102 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 7103 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 7104 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7105 /*CStyle=*/false, 7106 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 7107 if (ICS.isFailure()) 7108 return Incompatible; 7109 Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 7110 ICS, AA_Assigning); 7111 } 7112 if (Res.isInvalid()) 7113 return Incompatible; 7114 Sema::AssignConvertType result = Compatible; 7115 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 7116 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType, 7117 RHS.get()->getType())) 7118 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 7119 RHS = Res; 7120 return result; 7121 } 7122 7123 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C 7124 // structures. 7125 // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should 7126 // happen there, though. 7127 } 7128 7129 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is 7130 // a null pointer constant. 7131 if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 7132 LHSType->isBlockPointerType()) && 7133 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 7134 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 7135 CastKind Kind; 7136 CXXCastPath Path; 7137 CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, Path, false); 7138 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, VK_RValue, &Path); 7139 return Compatible; 7140 } 7141 7142 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper 7143 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all 7144 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary 7145 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof). 7146 // 7147 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5. 7148 if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) { 7149 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 7150 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 7151 return Incompatible; 7152 } 7153 7154 Expr *PRE = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts(); 7155 if (ObjCProtocolExpr *OPE = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolExpr>(PRE)) { 7156 ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = OPE->getProtocol(); 7157 if (PDecl && !PDecl->hasDefinition()) { 7158 Diag(PRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_atprotocol_protocol) << PDecl->getName(); 7159 Diag(PDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PDecl; 7160 } 7161 } 7162 7163 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid; 7164 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 7165 CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind); 7166 7167 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the 7168 // type of the assignment expression. 7169 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference, 7170 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C. 7171 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression 7172 // does not have reference type. 7173 if (result != Incompatible && RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType) { 7174 QualType Ty = LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7175 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 7176 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 7177 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), Ty, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, 7178 DiagnoseCFAudited); 7179 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && 7180 (CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(E->getLocStart(), 7181 LHSType, E->getType(), E) || 7182 ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(LHSType, E))) { 7183 RHS = E; 7184 return Compatible; 7185 } 7186 7187 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty, Kind); 7188 } 7189 return result; 7190 } 7191 7192 QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS, 7193 ExprResult &RHS) { 7194 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands) 7195 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 7196 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7197 return QualType(); 7198 } 7199 7200 /// Try to convert a value of non-vector type to a vector type by converting 7201 /// the type to the element type of the vector and then performing a splat. 7202 /// If the language is OpenCL, we only use conversions that promote scalar 7203 /// rank; for C, Obj-C, and C++ we allow any real scalar conversion except 7204 /// for float->int. 7205 /// 7206 /// \param scalar - if non-null, actually perform the conversions 7207 /// \return true if the operation fails (but without diagnosing the failure) 7208 static bool tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *scalar, 7209 QualType scalarTy, 7210 QualType vectorEltTy, 7211 QualType vectorTy) { 7212 // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it, 7213 // if necessary. 7214 CastKind scalarCast = CK_Invalid; 7215 7216 if (vectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 7217 if (!scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 7218 return true; 7219 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 7220 S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0) 7221 return true; 7222 scalarCast = CK_IntegralCast; 7223 } else if (vectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 7224 if (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 7225 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 7226 S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0) 7227 return true; 7228 scalarCast = CK_FloatingCast; 7229 } 7230 else if (scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 7231 scalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating; 7232 else 7233 return true; 7234 } else { 7235 return true; 7236 } 7237 7238 // Adjust scalar if desired. 7239 if (scalar) { 7240 if (scalarCast != CK_Invalid) 7241 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorEltTy, scalarCast); 7242 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 7243 } 7244 return false; 7245 } 7246 7247 QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7248 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 7249 if (!IsCompAssign) { 7250 LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 7251 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 7252 return QualType(); 7253 } 7254 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 7255 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 7256 return QualType(); 7257 7258 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 7259 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 7260 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 7261 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 7262 7263 // If the vector types are identical, return. 7264 if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType)) 7265 return LHSType; 7266 7267 const VectorType *LHSVecType = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 7268 const VectorType *RHSVecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 7269 assert(LHSVecType || RHSVecType); 7270 7271 // If we have compatible AltiVec and GCC vector types, use the AltiVec type. 7272 if (LHSVecType && RHSVecType && 7273 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 7274 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 7275 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 7276 return LHSType; 7277 } 7278 7279 if (!IsCompAssign) 7280 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 7281 return RHSType; 7282 } 7283 7284 // If there's an ext-vector type and a scalar, try to convert the scalar to 7285 // the vector element type and splat. 7286 if (!RHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 7287 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, RHSType, 7288 LHSVecType->getElementType(), LHSType)) 7289 return LHSType; 7290 } 7291 if (!LHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) { 7292 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, (IsCompAssign ? nullptr : &LHS), 7293 LHSType, RHSVecType->getElementType(), 7294 RHSType)) 7295 return RHSType; 7296 } 7297 7298 // If we're allowing lax vector conversions, only the total (data) size 7299 // needs to be the same. 7300 // FIXME: Should we really be allowing this? 7301 // FIXME: We really just pick the LHS type arbitrarily? 7302 if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 7303 QualType resultType = LHSType; 7304 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), resultType, CK_BitCast); 7305 return resultType; 7306 } 7307 7308 // Okay, the expression is invalid. 7309 7310 // If there's a non-vector, non-real operand, diagnose that. 7311 if ((!RHSVecType && !RHSType->isRealType()) || 7312 (!LHSVecType && !LHSType->isRealType())) { 7313 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar) 7314 << LHSType << RHSType 7315 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7316 return QualType(); 7317 } 7318 7319 // Otherwise, use the generic diagnostic. 7320 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable) 7321 << LHSType << RHSType 7322 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7323 return QualType(); 7324 } 7325 7326 // checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an 7327 // expression. These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an 7328 // integer instead of a pointer. 7329 static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7330 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) { 7331 // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant, 7332 // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively 7333 // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow. 7334 bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 7335 bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 7336 7337 QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType(); 7338 7339 // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and 7340 // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about. 7341 if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() || 7342 NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType()) 7343 return; 7344 7345 // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter 7346 // what the other expression is. 7347 if (!IsCompare) { 7348 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation) 7349 << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7350 << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 7351 return; 7352 } 7353 7354 // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer 7355 // if the other expression is a pointer. 7356 if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() || 7357 NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType()) 7358 return; 7359 7360 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation) 7361 << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType 7362 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7363 } 7364 7365 QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7366 SourceLocation Loc, 7367 bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) { 7368 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7369 7370 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7371 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 7372 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 7373 7374 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 7375 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7376 return QualType(); 7377 7378 7379 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isArithmeticType()) 7380 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7381 7382 // Check for division by zero. 7383 llvm::APSInt RHSValue; 7384 if (IsDiv && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 7385 RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0) 7386 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 7387 PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero) 7388 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7389 7390 return compType; 7391 } 7392 7393 QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands( 7394 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 7395 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7396 7397 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7398 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7399 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 7400 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 7401 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 7402 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7403 } 7404 7405 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 7406 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7407 return QualType(); 7408 7409 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isIntegerType()) 7410 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7411 7412 // Check for remainder by zero. 7413 llvm::APSInt RHSValue; 7414 if (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 7415 RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0) 7416 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 7417 PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero) 7418 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7419 7420 return compType; 7421 } 7422 7423 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers. 7424 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7425 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7426 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7427 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 7428 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 7429 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 7430 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 7431 } 7432 7433 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer. 7434 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7435 Expr *Pointer) { 7436 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7437 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 7438 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 7439 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 7440 } 7441 7442 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers. 7443 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7444 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 7445 assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7446 assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7447 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7448 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 7449 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 7450 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 7451 // We only show the second type if it differs from the first. 7452 << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(), 7453 RHS->getType()) 7454 << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 7455 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 7456 } 7457 7458 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer. 7459 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7460 Expr *Pointer) { 7461 assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7462 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7463 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 7464 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 7465 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType() 7466 << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */ 7467 << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 7468 } 7469 7470 /// \brief Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type 7471 /// 7472 /// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type 7473 static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7474 Expr *Operand) { 7475 QualType ResType = Operand->getType(); 7476 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 7477 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 7478 7479 assert(ResType->isAnyPointerType() && !ResType->isDependentType()); 7480 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType(); 7481 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy, 7482 diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type, 7483 PointeeTy, Operand->getSourceRange()); 7484 } 7485 7486 /// \brief Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand. 7487 /// 7488 /// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types 7489 /// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed 7490 /// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an 7491 /// extension. 7492 /// 7493 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 7494 static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7495 Expr *Operand) { 7496 QualType ResType = Operand->getType(); 7497 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 7498 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 7499 7500 if (!ResType->isAnyPointerType()) return true; 7501 7502 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType(); 7503 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) { 7504 diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 7505 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7506 } 7507 if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 7508 diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 7509 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7510 } 7511 7512 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false; 7513 7514 return true; 7515 } 7516 7517 /// \brief Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer 7518 /// operands. 7519 /// 7520 /// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much 7521 /// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic 7522 /// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS 7523 /// are (potentially problematic) pointers. 7524 /// 7525 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 7526 static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7527 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7528 bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 7529 bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 7530 if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true; 7531 7532 QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy; 7533 if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 7534 if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 7535 7536 // if both are pointers check if operation is valid wrt address spaces 7537 if (isLHSPointer && isRHSPointer) { 7538 const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 7539 const PointerType *rhsPtr = RHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 7540 if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*rhsPtr)) { 7541 S.Diag(Loc, 7542 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 7543 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << 1 /*arithmetic op*/ 7544 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 7545 return false; 7546 } 7547 } 7548 7549 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types. 7550 bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 7551 bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 7552 if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) { 7553 if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 7554 else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr); 7555 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 7556 7557 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7558 } 7559 7560 bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 7561 bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 7562 if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) { 7563 if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 7564 else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, 7565 RHSExpr); 7566 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 7567 7568 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7569 } 7570 7571 if (isLHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr)) 7572 return false; 7573 if (isRHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr)) 7574 return false; 7575 7576 return true; 7577 } 7578 7579 /// diagnoseStringPlusInt - Emit a warning when adding an integer to a string 7580 /// literal. 7581 static void diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 7582 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7583 StringLiteral* StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7584 Expr* IndexExpr = RHSExpr; 7585 if (!StrExpr) { 7586 StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7587 IndexExpr = LHSExpr; 7588 } 7589 7590 bool IsStringPlusInt = StrExpr && 7591 IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 7592 if (!IsStringPlusInt || IndexExpr->isValueDependent()) 7593 return; 7594 7595 llvm::APSInt index; 7596 if (IndexExpr->EvaluateAsInt(index, Self.getASTContext())) { 7597 unsigned StrLenWithNull = StrExpr->getLength() + 1; 7598 if (index.isNonNegative() && 7599 index <= llvm::APSInt(llvm::APInt(index.getBitWidth(), StrLenWithNull), 7600 index.isUnsigned())) 7601 return; 7602 } 7603 7604 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7605 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_int) 7606 << DiagRange << IndexExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 7607 7608 // Only print a fixit for "str" + int, not for int + "str". 7609 if (IndexExpr == RHSExpr) { 7610 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7611 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 7612 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&") 7613 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 7614 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 7615 } else 7616 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 7617 } 7618 7619 /// \brief Emit a warning when adding a char literal to a string. 7620 static void diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 7621 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7622 const Expr *StringRefExpr = LHSExpr; 7623 const CharacterLiteral *CharExpr = 7624 dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7625 7626 if (!CharExpr) { 7627 CharExpr = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7628 StringRefExpr = RHSExpr; 7629 } 7630 7631 if (!CharExpr || !StringRefExpr) 7632 return; 7633 7634 const QualType StringType = StringRefExpr->getType(); 7635 7636 // Return if not a PointerType. 7637 if (!StringType->isAnyPointerType()) 7638 return; 7639 7640 // Return if not a CharacterType. 7641 if (!StringType->getPointeeType()->isAnyCharacterType()) 7642 return; 7643 7644 ASTContext &Ctx = Self.getASTContext(); 7645 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7646 7647 const QualType CharType = CharExpr->getType(); 7648 if (!CharType->isAnyCharacterType() && 7649 CharType->isIntegerType() && 7650 llvm::isUIntN(Ctx.getCharWidth(), CharExpr->getValue())) { 7651 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 7652 << DiagRange << Ctx.CharTy; 7653 } else { 7654 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 7655 << DiagRange << CharExpr->getType(); 7656 } 7657 7658 // Only print a fixit for str + char, not for char + str. 7659 if (isa<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts())) { 7660 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7661 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 7662 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&") 7663 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 7664 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 7665 } else { 7666 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 7667 } 7668 } 7669 7670 /// \brief Emit error when two pointers are incompatible. 7671 static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7672 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7673 assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7674 assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7675 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible) 7676 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 7677 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 7678 } 7679 7680 QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6 7681 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc, 7682 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 7683 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7684 7685 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7686 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7687 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy); 7688 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7689 return compType; 7690 } 7691 7692 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 7693 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7694 return QualType(); 7695 7696 // Diagnose "string literal" '+' int and string '+' "char literal". 7697 if (Opc == BO_Add) { 7698 diagnoseStringPlusInt(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7699 diagnoseStringPlusChar(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7700 } 7701 7702 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 7703 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 7704 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7705 return compType; 7706 } 7707 7708 // Type-checking. Ultimately the pointer's going to be in PExp; 7709 // note that we bias towards the LHS being the pointer. 7710 Expr *PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get(); 7711 7712 bool isObjCPointer; 7713 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 7714 isObjCPointer = false; 7715 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7716 isObjCPointer = true; 7717 } else { 7718 std::swap(PExp, IExp); 7719 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 7720 isObjCPointer = false; 7721 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7722 isObjCPointer = true; 7723 } else { 7724 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7725 } 7726 } 7727 assert(PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7728 7729 if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) 7730 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7731 7732 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp)) 7733 return QualType(); 7734 7735 if (isObjCPointer && checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, PExp)) 7736 return QualType(); 7737 7738 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 7739 CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp); 7740 7741 if (CompLHSTy) { 7742 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 7743 if (LHSTy.isNull()) { 7744 LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7745 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType()) 7746 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy); 7747 } 7748 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy; 7749 } 7750 7751 return PExp->getType(); 7752 } 7753 7754 // C99 6.5.6 7755 QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7756 SourceLocation Loc, 7757 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 7758 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7759 7760 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7761 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7762 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy); 7763 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7764 return compType; 7765 } 7766 7767 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 7768 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7769 return QualType(); 7770 7771 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3. 7772 7773 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 7774 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 7775 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7776 return compType; 7777 } 7778 7779 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr. 7780 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) { 7781 QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType(); 7782 7783 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts. 7784 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 7785 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 7786 return QualType(); 7787 7788 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type. 7789 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) { 7790 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 7791 return QualType(); 7792 7793 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 7794 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), /*ArraySubscriptExpr*/nullptr, 7795 /*AllowOnePastEnd*/true, /*IndexNegated*/true); 7796 7797 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7798 return LHS.get()->getType(); 7799 } 7800 7801 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions. 7802 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy 7803 = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 7804 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType(); 7805 7806 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7807 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add] 7808 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) { 7809 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7810 } 7811 } else { 7812 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3 7813 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible( 7814 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(), 7815 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) { 7816 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7817 return QualType(); 7818 } 7819 } 7820 7821 if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc, 7822 LHS.get(), RHS.get())) 7823 return QualType(); 7824 7825 // The pointee type may have zero size. As an extension, a structure or 7826 // union may have zero size or an array may have zero length. In this 7827 // case subtraction does not make sense. 7828 if (!rpointee->isVoidType() && !rpointee->isFunctionType()) { 7829 CharUnits ElementSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(rpointee); 7830 if (ElementSize.isZero()) { 7831 Diag(Loc,diag::warn_sub_ptr_zero_size_types) 7832 << rpointee.getUnqualifiedType() 7833 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7834 } 7835 } 7836 7837 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7838 return Context.getPointerDiffType(); 7839 } 7840 } 7841 7842 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7843 } 7844 7845 static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) { 7846 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 7847 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped(); 7848 return false; 7849 } 7850 7851 static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7852 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc, 7853 QualType LHSType) { 7854 // OpenCL 6.3j: shift values are effectively % word size of LHS (more defined), 7855 // so skip remaining warnings as we don't want to modify values within Sema. 7856 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) 7857 return; 7858 7859 llvm::APSInt Right; 7860 // Check right/shifter operand 7861 if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 7862 !RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Right, S.Context)) 7863 return; 7864 7865 if (Right.isNegative()) { 7866 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 7867 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative) 7868 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7869 return; 7870 } 7871 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(), 7872 S.Context.getTypeSize(LHS.get()->getType())); 7873 if (Right.uge(LeftBits)) { 7874 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 7875 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) 7876 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7877 return; 7878 } 7879 if (Opc != BO_Shl) 7880 return; 7881 7882 // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which 7883 // according to C++ has undefined behavior ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned 7884 // integers have defined behavior modulo one more than the maximum value 7885 // representable in the result type, so never warn for those. 7886 llvm::APSInt Left; 7887 if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 7888 !LHS.get()->isIntegerConstantExpr(Left, S.Context) || 7889 LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation()) 7890 return; 7891 llvm::APInt ResultBits = 7892 static_cast<llvm::APInt&>(Right) + Left.getMinSignedBits(); 7893 if (LeftBits.uge(ResultBits)) 7894 return; 7895 llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue()); 7896 Result = Result.shl(Right); 7897 7898 // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned 7899 // hexadecimal number. 7900 SmallString<40> HexResult; 7901 Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true); 7902 7903 // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual 7904 // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the 7905 // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be 7906 // turned off separately if needed. 7907 if (LeftBits == ResultBits - 1) { 7908 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit) 7909 << HexResult << LHSType 7910 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7911 return; 7912 } 7913 7914 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth) 7915 << HexResult.str() << Result.getMinSignedBits() << LHSType 7916 << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 7917 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7918 } 7919 7920 /// \brief Return the resulting type when an OpenCL vector is shifted 7921 /// by a scalar or vector shift amount. 7922 static QualType checkOpenCLVectorShift(Sema &S, 7923 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7924 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 7925 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says RHS can be a vector only if LHS is a vector. 7926 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7927 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_shift_rhs_only_vector) 7928 << RHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getType() 7929 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7930 return QualType(); 7931 } 7932 7933 if (!IsCompAssign) { 7934 LHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 7935 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 7936 } 7937 7938 RHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 7939 if (RHS.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 7940 7941 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 7942 const VectorType *LHSVecTy = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 7943 QualType LHSEleType = LHSVecTy->getElementType(); 7944 7945 // Note that RHS might not be a vector. 7946 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 7947 const VectorType *RHSVecTy = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 7948 QualType RHSEleType = RHSVecTy ? RHSVecTy->getElementType() : RHSType; 7949 7950 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says that the operands need to be integers. 7951 if (!LHSEleType->isIntegerType()) { 7952 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int) 7953 << LHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7954 return QualType(); 7955 } 7956 7957 if (!RHSEleType->isIntegerType()) { 7958 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int) 7959 << RHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7960 return QualType(); 7961 } 7962 7963 if (RHSVecTy) { 7964 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says that for vector types, the operators 7965 // are applied component-wise. So if RHS is a vector, then ensure 7966 // that the number of elements is the same as LHS... 7967 if (RHSVecTy->getNumElements() != LHSVecTy->getNumElements()) { 7968 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_lengths_not_equal) 7969 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 7970 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7971 return QualType(); 7972 } 7973 } else { 7974 // ...else expand RHS to match the number of elements in LHS. 7975 QualType VecTy = 7976 S.Context.getExtVectorType(RHSEleType, LHSVecTy->getNumElements()); 7977 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat); 7978 } 7979 7980 return LHSType; 7981 } 7982 7983 // C99 6.5.7 7984 QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7985 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc, 7986 bool IsCompAssign) { 7987 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7988 7989 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type. 7990 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7991 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7992 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) 7993 return checkOpenCLVectorShift(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 7994 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 7995 } 7996 7997 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer 7998 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3 7999 8000 // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away 8001 // if this is a compound assignment. 8002 ExprResult OldLHS = LHS; 8003 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 8004 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 8005 return QualType(); 8006 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 8007 if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS; 8008 8009 // The RHS is simpler. 8010 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 8011 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8012 return QualType(); 8013 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8014 8015 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type. 8016 if (!LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation() || 8017 !RHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 8018 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8019 8020 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than 8021 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this. 8022 if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHSType) || 8023 isScopedEnumerationType(RHSType)) { 8024 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8025 } 8026 // Sanity-check shift operands 8027 DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType); 8028 8029 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand." 8030 return LHSType; 8031 } 8032 8033 static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) { 8034 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) { 8035 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC)) 8036 return true; 8037 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)) 8038 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization(); 8039 } 8040 return false; 8041 } 8042 8043 /// If two different enums are compared, raise a warning. 8044 static void checkEnumComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *LHS, 8045 Expr *RHS) { 8046 QualType LHSStrippedType = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 8047 QualType RHSStrippedType = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 8048 8049 const EnumType *LHSEnumType = LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 8050 if (!LHSEnumType) 8051 return; 8052 const EnumType *RHSEnumType = RHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 8053 if (!RHSEnumType) 8054 return; 8055 8056 // Ignore anonymous enums. 8057 if (!LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier()) 8058 return; 8059 if (!RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier()) 8060 return; 8061 8062 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType)) 8063 return; 8064 8065 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_of_mixed_enum_types) 8066 << LHSStrippedType << RHSStrippedType 8067 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 8068 } 8069 8070 /// \brief Diagnose bad pointer comparisons. 8071 static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8072 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8073 bool IsError) { 8074 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers 8075 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers) 8076 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 8077 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8078 } 8079 8080 /// \brief Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type, 8081 /// true otherwise. 8082 static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8083 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) { 8084 // C++ [expr.rel]p2: 8085 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification 8086 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on 8087 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring 8088 // them to their composite pointer type. [...] 8089 // 8090 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality 8091 // comparisons of pointers. 8092 8093 // C++ [expr.eq]p2: 8094 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to 8095 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions 8096 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring 8097 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant, 8098 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the 8099 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type 8100 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4) 8101 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand 8102 // types. 8103 8104 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 8105 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8106 assert((LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) || 8107 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType())); 8108 8109 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false; 8110 bool *BoolPtr = S.isSFINAEContext() ? nullptr : &NonStandardCompositeType; 8111 QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS, BoolPtr); 8112 if (T.isNull()) { 8113 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true); 8114 return true; 8115 } 8116 8117 if (NonStandardCompositeType) 8118 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard) 8119 << LHSType << RHSType << T << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8120 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8121 8122 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 8123 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 8124 return false; 8125 } 8126 8127 static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8128 ExprResult &LHS, 8129 ExprResult &RHS, 8130 bool IsError) { 8131 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void 8132 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void) 8133 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 8134 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8135 } 8136 8137 static bool isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult &E) { 8138 switch (E.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getStmtClass()) { 8139 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 8140 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 8141 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 8142 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: 8143 return true; 8144 default: 8145 // Note that ObjCBoolLiteral is NOT an object literal! 8146 return false; 8147 } 8148 } 8149 8150 static bool hasIsEqualMethod(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS) { 8151 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Type = 8152 LHS->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 8153 8154 // If this is not actually an Objective-C object, bail out. 8155 if (!Type) 8156 return false; 8157 8158 // Get the LHS object's interface type. 8159 QualType InterfaceType = Type->getPointeeType(); 8160 if (const ObjCObjectType *iQFaceTy = 8161 InterfaceType->getAsObjCQualifiedInterfaceType()) 8162 InterfaceType = iQFaceTy->getBaseType(); 8163 8164 // If the RHS isn't an Objective-C object, bail out. 8165 if (!RHS->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 8166 return false; 8167 8168 // Try to find the -isEqual: method. 8169 Selector IsEqualSel = S.NSAPIObj->getIsEqualSelector(); 8170 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = S.LookupMethodInObjectType(IsEqualSel, 8171 InterfaceType, 8172 /*instance=*/true); 8173 if (!Method) { 8174 if (Type->isObjCIdType()) { 8175 // For 'id', just check the global pool. 8176 Method = S.LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(IsEqualSel, SourceRange(), 8177 /*receiverId=*/true); 8178 } else { 8179 // Check protocols. 8180 Method = S.LookupMethodInQualifiedType(IsEqualSel, Type, 8181 /*instance=*/true); 8182 } 8183 } 8184 8185 if (!Method) 8186 return false; 8187 8188 QualType T = Method->parameters()[0]->getType(); 8189 if (!T->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 8190 return false; 8191 8192 QualType R = Method->getReturnType(); 8193 if (!R->isScalarType()) 8194 return false; 8195 8196 return true; 8197 } 8198 8199 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind Sema::CheckLiteralKind(Expr *FromE) { 8200 FromE = FromE->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8201 switch (FromE->getStmtClass()) { 8202 default: 8203 break; 8204 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 8205 // "string literal" 8206 return LK_String; 8207 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 8208 // "array literal" 8209 return LK_Array; 8210 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 8211 // "dictionary literal" 8212 return LK_Dictionary; 8213 case Stmt::BlockExprClass: 8214 return LK_Block; 8215 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: { 8216 Expr *Inner = cast<ObjCBoxedExpr>(FromE)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 8217 switch (Inner->getStmtClass()) { 8218 case Stmt::IntegerLiteralClass: 8219 case Stmt::FloatingLiteralClass: 8220 case Stmt::CharacterLiteralClass: 8221 case Stmt::ObjCBoolLiteralExprClass: 8222 case Stmt::CXXBoolLiteralExprClass: 8223 // "numeric literal" 8224 return LK_Numeric; 8225 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: { 8226 CastKind CK = cast<CastExpr>(Inner)->getCastKind(); 8227 // Boolean literals can be represented by implicit casts. 8228 if (CK == CK_IntegralToBoolean || CK == CK_IntegralCast) 8229 return LK_Numeric; 8230 break; 8231 } 8232 default: 8233 break; 8234 } 8235 return LK_Boxed; 8236 } 8237 } 8238 return LK_None; 8239 } 8240 8241 static void diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8242 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8243 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc){ 8244 Expr *Literal; 8245 Expr *Other; 8246 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS)) { 8247 Literal = LHS.get(); 8248 Other = RHS.get(); 8249 } else { 8250 Literal = RHS.get(); 8251 Other = LHS.get(); 8252 } 8253 8254 // Don't warn on comparisons against nil. 8255 Other = Other->IgnoreParenCasts(); 8256 if (Other->isNullPointerConstant(S.getASTContext(), 8257 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) 8258 return; 8259 8260 // This should be kept in sync with warn_objc_literal_comparison. 8261 // LK_String should always be after the other literals, since it has its own 8262 // warning flag. 8263 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind LiteralKind = S.CheckLiteralKind(Literal); 8264 assert(LiteralKind != Sema::LK_Block); 8265 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_None) { 8266 llvm_unreachable("Unknown Objective-C object literal kind"); 8267 } 8268 8269 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_String) 8270 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_string_literal_comparison) 8271 << Literal->getSourceRange(); 8272 else 8273 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_literal_comparison) 8274 << LiteralKind << Literal->getSourceRange(); 8275 8276 if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) && 8277 hasIsEqualMethod(S, LHS.get(), RHS.get())) { 8278 SourceLocation Start = LHS.get()->getLocStart(); 8279 SourceLocation End = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd()); 8280 CharSourceRange OpRange = 8281 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc)); 8282 8283 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_objc_literal_comparison_isequal) 8284 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Start, Opc == BO_EQ ? "[" : "![") 8285 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpRange, " isEqual:") 8286 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, "]"); 8287 } 8288 } 8289 8290 static void diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 8291 ExprResult &RHS, 8292 SourceLocation Loc, 8293 unsigned OpaqueOpc) { 8294 // This checking requires bools. 8295 if (!S.getLangOpts().Bool) return; 8296 8297 // Check that left hand side is !something. 8298 UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 8299 if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != UO_LNot) return; 8300 8301 // Only check if the right hand side is non-bool arithmetic type. 8302 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType()) return; 8303 8304 // Make sure that the something in !something is not bool. 8305 Expr *SubExpr = UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts(); 8306 if (SubExpr->getType()->isBooleanType()) return; 8307 8308 // Emit warning. 8309 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_not_on_lhs_of_comparison) 8310 << Loc; 8311 8312 // First note suggest !(x < y) 8313 SourceLocation FirstOpen = SubExpr->getLocStart(); 8314 SourceLocation FirstClose = RHS.get()->getLocEnd(); 8315 FirstClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(FirstClose); 8316 if (FirstClose.isInvalid()) 8317 FirstOpen = SourceLocation(); 8318 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_fix) 8319 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstOpen, "(") 8320 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstClose, ")"); 8321 8322 // Second note suggests (!x) < y 8323 SourceLocation SecondOpen = LHS.get()->getLocStart(); 8324 SourceLocation SecondClose = LHS.get()->getLocEnd(); 8325 SecondClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(SecondClose); 8326 if (SecondClose.isInvalid()) 8327 SecondOpen = SourceLocation(); 8328 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_silence_with_parens) 8329 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondOpen, "(") 8330 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondClose, ")"); 8331 } 8332 8333 // Get the decl for a simple expression: a reference to a variable, 8334 // an implicit C++ field reference, or an implicit ObjC ivar reference. 8335 static ValueDecl *getCompareDecl(Expr *E) { 8336 if (DeclRefExpr* DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 8337 return DR->getDecl(); 8338 if (ObjCIvarRefExpr* Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) { 8339 if (Ivar->isFreeIvar()) 8340 return Ivar->getDecl(); 8341 } 8342 if (MemberExpr* Mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 8343 if (Mem->isImplicitAccess()) 8344 return Mem->getMemberDecl(); 8345 } 8346 return nullptr; 8347 } 8348 8349 // C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel] 8350 QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8351 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned OpaqueOpc, 8352 bool IsRelational) { 8353 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/true); 8354 8355 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc; 8356 8357 // Handle vector comparisons separately. 8358 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 8359 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 8360 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsRelational); 8361 8362 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 8363 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8364 8365 Expr *LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8366 Expr *RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8367 8368 checkEnumComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 8369 diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, OpaqueOpc); 8370 8371 if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() && 8372 !(LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && IsRelational) && 8373 !LHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() && 8374 !RHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() && 8375 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 8376 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 8377 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 8378 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 8379 // 8380 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro 8381 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self 8382 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch 8383 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to 8384 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same 8385 // result. 8386 ValueDecl *DL = getCompareDecl(LHSStripped); 8387 ValueDecl *DR = getCompareDecl(RHSStripped); 8388 if (DL && DR && DL == DR && !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DL)) { 8389 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 8390 << 0 // self- 8391 << (Opc == BO_EQ 8392 || Opc == BO_LE 8393 || Opc == BO_GE)); 8394 } else if (DL && DR && LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType() && 8395 !DL->getType()->isReferenceType() && 8396 !DR->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 8397 // what is it always going to eval to? 8398 char always_evals_to; 8399 switch(Opc) { 8400 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2 8401 always_evals_to = 0; // false 8402 break; 8403 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2 8404 always_evals_to = 1; // true 8405 break; 8406 default: 8407 // best we can say is 'a constant' 8408 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2 8409 break; 8410 } 8411 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 8412 << 1 // array 8413 << always_evals_to); 8414 } 8415 8416 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped)) 8417 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 8418 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped)) 8419 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 8420 8421 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other 8422 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp. 8423 Expr *literalString = nullptr; 8424 Expr *literalStringStripped = nullptr; 8425 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) && 8426 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 8427 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 8428 literalString = LHS.get(); 8429 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped; 8430 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) || 8431 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) && 8432 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 8433 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 8434 literalString = RHS.get(); 8435 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped; 8436 } 8437 8438 if (literalString) { 8439 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 8440 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare) 8441 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped) 8442 << literalString->getSourceRange()); 8443 } 8444 } 8445 8446 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4 8447 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 8448 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 8449 return QualType(); 8450 8451 LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 8452 RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8453 8454 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C. 8455 QualType ResultTy = Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 8456 8457 if (IsRelational) { 8458 if (LHSType->isRealType() && RHSType->isRealType()) 8459 return ResultTy; 8460 } else { 8461 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 8462 if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 8463 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 8464 8465 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType()) 8466 return ResultTy; 8467 } 8468 8469 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind LHSNullKind = 8470 LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 8471 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind RHSNullKind = 8472 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 8473 bool LHSIsNull = LHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 8474 bool RHSIsNull = RHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 8475 8476 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) { 8477 bool IsEquality = Opc == BO_EQ; 8478 if (RHSIsNull) 8479 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(LHS.get(), RHSNullKind, IsEquality, 8480 RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 8481 else 8482 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(RHS.get(), LHSNullKind, IsEquality, 8483 LHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 8484 } 8485 8486 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except 8487 // when handling null pointer constants. 8488 if (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2 8489 QualType LCanPointeeTy = 8490 LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 8491 QualType RCanPointeeTy = 8492 RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 8493 8494 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8495 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy) 8496 return ResultTy; 8497 if (!IsRelational && 8498 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) { 8499 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer 8500 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison. 8501 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain 8502 // conformance with the C++ standard. 8503 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 8504 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 8505 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison( 8506 *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ (bool)isSFINAEContext()); 8507 8508 if (isSFINAEContext()) 8509 return QualType(); 8510 8511 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8512 return ResultTy; 8513 } 8514 } 8515 8516 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 8517 return QualType(); 8518 else 8519 return ResultTy; 8520 } 8521 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2 8522 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(), 8523 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) { 8524 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers 8525 if (IsRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 8526 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers) 8527 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8528 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8529 } 8530 } else if (!IsRelational && 8531 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) { 8532 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer 8533 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 8534 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8535 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 8536 /*isError*/false); 8537 } else { 8538 // Invalid 8539 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false); 8540 } 8541 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) { 8542 const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 8543 if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())) { 8544 Diag(Loc, 8545 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 8546 << LHSType << RHSType << 0 /* comparison */ 8547 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8548 } 8549 unsigned AddrSpaceL = LCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 8550 unsigned AddrSpaceR = RCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 8551 CastKind Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion 8552 : CK_BitCast; 8553 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8554 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, Kind); 8555 else 8556 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind); 8557 } 8558 return ResultTy; 8559 } 8560 8561 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8562 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself. 8563 if (LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isNullPtrType()) 8564 return ResultTy; 8565 8566 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality 8567 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants. 8568 if (RHSIsNull && 8569 ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() || LHSType->isNullPtrType()) || 8570 (!IsRelational && 8571 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) { 8572 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 8573 LHSType->isMemberPointerType() 8574 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer 8575 : CK_NullToPointer); 8576 return ResultTy; 8577 } 8578 if (LHSIsNull && 8579 ((RHSType->isAnyPointerType() || RHSType->isNullPtrType()) || 8580 (!IsRelational && 8581 (RHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) { 8582 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 8583 RHSType->isMemberPointerType() 8584 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer 8585 : CK_NullToPointer); 8586 return ResultTy; 8587 } 8588 8589 // Comparison of member pointers. 8590 if (!IsRelational && 8591 LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType()) { 8592 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 8593 return QualType(); 8594 else 8595 return ResultTy; 8596 } 8597 8598 // Handle scoped enumeration types specifically, since they don't promote 8599 // to integers. 8600 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isEnumeralType() && 8601 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS.get()->getType(), 8602 RHS.get()->getType())) 8603 return ResultTy; 8604 } 8605 8606 // Handle block pointer types. 8607 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 8608 RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 8609 QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 8610 QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 8611 8612 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull && 8613 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) { 8614 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 8615 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8616 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8617 } 8618 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8619 return ResultTy; 8620 } 8621 8622 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants. 8623 if (!IsRelational 8624 && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) 8625 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) { 8626 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 8627 if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 8628 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) 8629 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 8630 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()))) 8631 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 8632 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8633 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8634 } 8635 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8636 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 8637 RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 8638 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 8639 else 8640 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 8641 LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 8642 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 8643 return ResultTy; 8644 } 8645 8646 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 8647 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 8648 const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 8649 const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 8650 if (LPT || RPT) { 8651 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 8652 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 8653 8654 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid && 8655 !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 8656 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 8657 /*isError*/false); 8658 } 8659 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 8660 Expr *E = LHS.get(); 8661 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 8662 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), RHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion); 8663 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, RHSType, 8664 RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 8665 } 8666 else { 8667 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 8668 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 8669 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), LHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, false, 8670 Opc); 8671 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, LHSType, 8672 LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 8673 } 8674 return ResultTy; 8675 } 8676 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 8677 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 8678 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) 8679 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 8680 /*isError*/false); 8681 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS) || isObjCObjectLiteral(RHS)) 8682 diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, Opc); 8683 8684 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8685 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 8686 else 8687 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8688 return ResultTy; 8689 } 8690 } 8691 if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) || 8692 (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) { 8693 unsigned DiagID = 0; 8694 bool isError = false; 8695 if (LangOpts.DebuggerSupport) { 8696 // Under a debugger, allow the comparison of pointers to integers, 8697 // since users tend to want to compare addresses. 8698 } else if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) || 8699 (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) { 8700 if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 8701 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero; 8702 } else if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 8703 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 8704 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8705 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 8706 isError = true; 8707 } else 8708 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 8709 8710 if (DiagID) { 8711 Diag(Loc, DiagID) 8712 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8713 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8714 if (isError) 8715 return QualType(); 8716 } 8717 8718 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) 8719 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 8720 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 8721 else 8722 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 8723 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 8724 return ResultTy; 8725 } 8726 8727 // Handle block pointers. 8728 if (!IsRelational && RHSIsNull 8729 && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8730 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 8731 return ResultTy; 8732 } 8733 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull 8734 && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 8735 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 8736 return ResultTy; 8737 } 8738 8739 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8740 } 8741 8742 8743 // Return a signed type that is of identical size and number of elements. 8744 // For floating point vectors, return an integer type of identical size 8745 // and number of elements. 8746 QualType Sema::GetSignedVectorType(QualType V) { 8747 const VectorType *VTy = V->getAs<VectorType>(); 8748 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType()); 8749 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy)) 8750 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8751 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy)) 8752 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8753 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy)) 8754 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8755 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy)) 8756 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8757 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) && 8758 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare"); 8759 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8760 } 8761 8762 /// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that 8763 /// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result, 8764 /// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer 8765 /// types. 8766 QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8767 SourceLocation Loc, 8768 bool IsRelational) { 8769 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width, 8770 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type. 8771 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/false); 8772 if (vType.isNull()) 8773 return vType; 8774 8775 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 8776 8777 // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e. 8778 // bool for C++, int for C 8779 if (vType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) 8780 return Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 8781 8782 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 8783 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 8784 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 8785 if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() && 8786 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 8787 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL 8788 = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) 8789 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR 8790 = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) 8791 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl()) 8792 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 8793 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 8794 << 0 // self- 8795 << 2 // "a constant" 8796 ); 8797 } 8798 8799 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 8800 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) { 8801 assert (RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation()); 8802 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 8803 } 8804 8805 // Return a signed type for the vector. 8806 return GetSignedVectorType(LHSType); 8807 } 8808 8809 QualType Sema::CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8810 SourceLocation Loc) { 8811 // Ensure that either both operands are of the same vector type, or 8812 // one operand is of a vector type and the other is of its element type. 8813 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, false); 8814 if (vType.isNull()) 8815 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8816 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 && 8817 vType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 8818 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8819 8820 return GetSignedVectorType(LHS.get()->getType()); 8821 } 8822 8823 inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands( 8824 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 8825 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 8826 8827 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 8828 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 8829 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 8830 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 8831 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 8832 8833 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8834 } 8835 8836 ExprResult LHSResult = LHS, RHSResult = RHS; 8837 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHSResult, RHSResult, 8838 IsCompAssign); 8839 if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid()) 8840 return QualType(); 8841 LHS = LHSResult.get(); 8842 RHS = RHSResult.get(); 8843 8844 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 8845 return compType; 8846 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8847 } 8848 8849 inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14] 8850 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) { 8851 8852 // Check vector operands differently. 8853 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 8854 return CheckVectorLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc); 8855 8856 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a 8857 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS 8858 // is a constant. 8859 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && 8860 !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 8861 RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 8862 // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations. 8863 !Loc.isMacroID() && ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 8864 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something 8865 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that 8866 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn. 8867 // Parens on the RHS are ignored. 8868 llvm::APSInt Result; 8869 if (RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) 8870 if ((getLangOpts().Bool && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 8871 !RHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) || 8872 (Result != 0 && Result != 1)) { 8873 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise) 8874 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8875 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||"); 8876 // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version 8877 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator) 8878 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|") 8879 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange( 8880 Loc, Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(Loc, 0, getSourceManager(), 8881 getLangOpts())), 8882 Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|"); 8883 if (Opc == BO_LAnd) 8884 // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()" 8885 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant) 8886 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 8887 SourceRange( 8888 Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getLocEnd(), 8889 0, getSourceManager(), 8890 getLangOpts()), 8891 RHS.get()->getLocEnd())); 8892 } 8893 } 8894 8895 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8896 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.g: The logical operators and (&&), or (||) do 8897 // not operate on the built-in scalar and vector float types. 8898 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 8899 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 8900 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType() || 8901 RHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType()) 8902 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8903 } 8904 8905 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 8906 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 8907 return QualType(); 8908 8909 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 8910 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8911 return QualType(); 8912 8913 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() || 8914 !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType()) 8915 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8916 8917 return Context.IntTy; 8918 } 8919 8920 // The following is safe because we only use this method for 8921 // non-overloadable operands. 8922 8923 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1 8924 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1 8925 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool. 8926 ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get()); 8927 if (LHSRes.isInvalid()) 8928 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8929 LHS = LHSRes; 8930 8931 ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get()); 8932 if (RHSRes.isInvalid()) 8933 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8934 RHS = RHSRes; 8935 8936 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2 8937 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2 8938 // The result is a bool. 8939 return Context.BoolTy; 8940 } 8941 8942 static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) { 8943 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 8944 if (!ME) return false; 8945 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) return false; 8946 ObjCMessageExpr *Base = 8947 dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 8948 if (!Base) return false; 8949 return Base->getMethodDecl() != nullptr; 8950 } 8951 8952 /// Is the given expression (which must be 'const') a reference to a 8953 /// variable which was originally non-const, but which has become 8954 /// 'const' due to being captured within a block? 8955 enum NonConstCaptureKind { NCCK_None, NCCK_Block, NCCK_Lambda }; 8956 static NonConstCaptureKind isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 8957 assert(E->isLValue() && E->getType().isConstQualified()); 8958 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 8959 8960 // Must be a reference to a declaration from an enclosing scope. 8961 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 8962 if (!DRE) return NCCK_None; 8963 if (!DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) return NCCK_None; 8964 8965 // The declaration must be a variable which is not declared 'const'. 8966 VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 8967 if (!var) return NCCK_None; 8968 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) return NCCK_None; 8969 assert(var->hasLocalStorage() && "capture added 'const' to non-local?"); 8970 8971 // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda. 8972 DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext, *Prev = nullptr; 8973 while (DC != var->getDeclContext()) { 8974 Prev = DC; 8975 DC = DC->getParent(); 8976 } 8977 // Unless we have an init-capture, we've gone one step too far. 8978 if (!var->isInitCapture()) 8979 DC = Prev; 8980 return (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) ? NCCK_Block : NCCK_Lambda); 8981 } 8982 8983 static bool IsTypeModifiable(QualType Ty, bool IsDereference) { 8984 Ty = Ty.getNonReferenceType(); 8985 if (IsDereference && Ty->isPointerType()) 8986 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType(); 8987 return !Ty.isConstQualified(); 8988 } 8989 8990 /// Emit the "read-only variable not assignable" error and print notes to give 8991 /// more information about why the variable is not assignable, such as pointing 8992 /// to the declaration of a const variable, showing that a method is const, or 8993 /// that the function is returning a const reference. 8994 static void DiagnoseConstAssignment(Sema &S, const Expr *E, 8995 SourceLocation Loc) { 8996 // Update err_typecheck_assign_const and note_typecheck_assign_const 8997 // when this enum is changed. 8998 enum { 8999 ConstFunction, 9000 ConstVariable, 9001 ConstMember, 9002 ConstMethod, 9003 ConstUnknown, // Keep as last element 9004 }; 9005 9006 SourceRange ExprRange = E->getSourceRange(); 9007 9008 // Only emit one error on the first const found. All other consts will emit 9009 // a note to the error. 9010 bool DiagnosticEmitted = false; 9011 9012 // Track if the current expression is the result of a derefence, and if the 9013 // next checked expression is the result of a derefence. 9014 bool IsDereference = false; 9015 bool NextIsDereference = false; 9016 9017 // Loop to process MemberExpr chains. 9018 while (true) { 9019 IsDereference = NextIsDereference; 9020 NextIsDereference = false; 9021 9022 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9023 if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 9024 NextIsDereference = ME->isArrow(); 9025 const ValueDecl *VD = ME->getMemberDecl(); 9026 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) { 9027 // Mutable fields can be modified even if the class is const. 9028 if (Field->isMutable()) { 9029 assert(DiagnosticEmitted && "Expected diagnostic not emitted."); 9030 break; 9031 } 9032 9033 if (!IsTypeModifiable(Field->getType(), IsDereference)) { 9034 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 9035 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 9036 << ExprRange << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field 9037 << Field->getType(); 9038 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 9039 } 9040 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 9041 << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field << Field->getType() 9042 << Field->getSourceRange(); 9043 } 9044 E = ME->getBase(); 9045 continue; 9046 } else if (const VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD)) { 9047 if (VDecl->getType().isConstQualified()) { 9048 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 9049 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 9050 << ExprRange << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl 9051 << VDecl->getType(); 9052 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 9053 } 9054 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 9055 << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl << VDecl->getType() 9056 << VDecl->getSourceRange(); 9057 } 9058 // Static fields do not inherit constness from parents. 9059 break; 9060 } 9061 break; 9062 } // End MemberExpr 9063 break; 9064 } 9065 9066 if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 9067 // Function calls 9068 const FunctionDecl *FD = CE->getDirectCallee(); 9069 if (!IsTypeModifiable(FD->getReturnType(), IsDereference)) { 9070 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 9071 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange 9072 << ConstFunction << FD; 9073 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 9074 } 9075 S.Diag(FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(), 9076 diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 9077 << ConstFunction << FD << FD->getReturnType() 9078 << FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 9079 } 9080 } else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 9081 // Point to variable declaration. 9082 if (const ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl()) { 9083 if (!IsTypeModifiable(VD->getType(), IsDereference)) { 9084 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 9085 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 9086 << ExprRange << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType(); 9087 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 9088 } 9089 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 9090 << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType() << VD->getSourceRange(); 9091 } 9092 } 9093 } else if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(E)) { 9094 if (const DeclContext *DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext()) { 9095 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) { 9096 if (MD->isConst()) { 9097 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 9098 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange 9099 << ConstMethod << MD; 9100 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 9101 } 9102 S.Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 9103 << ConstMethod << MD << MD->getSourceRange(); 9104 } 9105 } 9106 } 9107 } 9108 9109 if (DiagnosticEmitted) 9110 return; 9111 9112 // Can't determine a more specific message, so display the generic error. 9113 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange << ConstUnknown; 9114 } 9115 9116 /// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not, 9117 /// emit an error and return true. If so, return false. 9118 static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) { 9119 assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 9120 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc; 9121 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context, 9122 &Loc); 9123 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S)) 9124 IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression; 9125 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid) 9126 return false; 9127 9128 unsigned DiagID = 0; 9129 bool NeedType = false; 9130 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2 9131 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: 9132 // Use a specialized diagnostic when we're assigning to an object 9133 // from an enclosing function or block. 9134 if (NonConstCaptureKind NCCK = isReferenceToNonConstCapture(S, E)) { 9135 if (NCCK == NCCK_Block) 9136 DiagID = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 9137 else 9138 DiagID = diag::err_lambda_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 9139 break; 9140 } 9141 9142 // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we 9143 // infer 'const'. These are always pseudo-strong variables. 9144 if (S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 9145 DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()); 9146 if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) { 9147 VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl()); 9148 9149 // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the 9150 // user actually wrote 'const'. 9151 if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() && 9152 (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() || 9153 !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) { 9154 // There are two pseudo-strong cases: 9155 // - self 9156 ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl(); 9157 if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl()) 9158 DiagID = method->isClassMethod() 9159 ? diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self_class_method 9160 : diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self; 9161 9162 // - fast enumeration variables 9163 else 9164 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration; 9165 9166 SourceRange Assign; 9167 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 9168 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 9169 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 9170 // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool 9171 // can do its job. 9172 return false; 9173 } 9174 } 9175 } 9176 9177 // If none of the special cases above are triggered, then this is a 9178 // simple const assignment. 9179 if (DiagID == 0) { 9180 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc); 9181 return true; 9182 } 9183 9184 break; 9185 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType: 9186 case Expr::MLV_ArrayTemporary: 9187 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue; 9188 NeedType = true; 9189 break; 9190 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType: 9191 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue; 9192 NeedType = true; 9193 break; 9194 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast: 9195 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported; 9196 break; 9197 case Expr::MLV_Valid: 9198 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid"); 9199 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression: 9200 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction: 9201 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary: 9202 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue; 9203 break; 9204 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType: 9205 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType: 9206 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(), 9207 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue, E); 9208 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents: 9209 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue; 9210 break; 9211 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty: 9212 llvm_unreachable("readonly properties should be processed differently"); 9213 case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression: 9214 DiagID = diag::error_readonly_message_assignment; 9215 break; 9216 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting: 9217 DiagID = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting; 9218 break; 9219 } 9220 9221 SourceRange Assign; 9222 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 9223 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 9224 if (NeedType) 9225 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 9226 else 9227 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 9228 return true; 9229 } 9230 9231 static void CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 9232 SourceLocation Loc, 9233 Sema &Sema) { 9234 // C / C++ fields 9235 MemberExpr *ML = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr); 9236 MemberExpr *MR = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(RHSExpr); 9237 if (ML && MR && ML->getMemberDecl() == MR->getMemberDecl()) { 9238 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(ML->getBase()) && isa<CXXThisExpr>(MR->getBase())) 9239 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 0; 9240 } 9241 9242 // Objective-C instance variables 9243 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OL = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 9244 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 9245 if (OL && OR && OL->getDecl() == OR->getDecl()) { 9246 DeclRefExpr *RL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OL->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 9247 DeclRefExpr *RR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OR->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 9248 if (RL && RR && RL->getDecl() == RR->getDecl()) 9249 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 1; 9250 } 9251 } 9252 9253 // C99 6.5.16.1 9254 QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS, 9255 SourceLocation Loc, 9256 QualType CompoundType) { 9257 assert(!LHSExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 9258 9259 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not. 9260 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this)) 9261 return QualType(); 9262 9263 QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType(); 9264 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() : 9265 CompoundType; 9266 AssignConvertType ConvTy; 9267 if (CompoundType.isNull()) { 9268 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get(); 9269 9270 CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHSExpr, RHSCheck, Loc, *this); 9271 9272 QualType LHSTy(LHSType); 9273 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS); 9274 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 9275 return QualType(); 9276 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types. 9277 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer && 9278 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) && 9279 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) || 9280 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) && 9281 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()))) 9282 ConvTy = Compatible; 9283 9284 if (ConvTy == Compatible && 9285 LHSType->isObjCObjectType()) 9286 Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_object_assignment) 9287 << LHSType; 9288 9289 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are 9290 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4" 9291 // instead of "x += 4". 9292 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck)) 9293 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr(); 9294 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) { 9295 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus || 9296 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) && 9297 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() && 9298 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent. 9299 Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() && 9300 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the 9301 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1". 9302 Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() && 9303 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) { 9304 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign) 9305 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-") 9306 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc()); 9307 } 9308 } 9309 9310 if (ConvTy == Compatible) { 9311 if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong) { 9312 // Warn about retain cycles where a block captures the LHS, but 9313 // not if the LHS is a simple variable into which the block is 9314 // being stored...unless that variable can be captured by reference! 9315 const Expr *InnerLHS = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 9316 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InnerLHS); 9317 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl()->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 9318 checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 9319 9320 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 9321 // Although this code can still have problems: 9322 // id x = self.weakProp; 9323 // id y = self.weakProp; 9324 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 9325 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 9326 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 9327 if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 9328 RHS.get()->getLocStart())) 9329 getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(RHS.get()); 9330 9331 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 9332 checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 9333 } 9334 } 9335 } else { 9336 // Compound assignment "x += y" 9337 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType); 9338 } 9339 9340 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType, 9341 RHS.get(), AA_Assigning)) 9342 return QualType(); 9343 9344 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr); 9345 9346 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the 9347 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case 9348 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand. 9349 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand 9350 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above). 9351 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left 9352 // operand. 9353 return (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 9354 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType()); 9355 } 9356 9357 // C99 6.5.17 9358 static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9359 SourceLocation Loc) { 9360 LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 9361 RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 9362 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9363 return QualType(); 9364 9365 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its 9366 // operands, but not unary promotions. 9367 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1). 9368 9369 // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the 9370 // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS. 9371 LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.get()); 9372 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 9373 return QualType(); 9374 9375 S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get()); 9376 9377 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9378 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 9379 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 9380 return QualType(); 9381 if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType()) 9382 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(), 9383 diag::err_incomplete_type); 9384 } 9385 9386 return RHS.get()->getType(); 9387 } 9388 9389 /// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine 9390 /// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions. 9391 static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, 9392 ExprValueKind &VK, 9393 ExprObjectKind &OK, 9394 SourceLocation OpLoc, 9395 bool IsInc, bool IsPrefix) { 9396 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 9397 return S.Context.DependentTy; 9398 9399 QualType ResType = Op->getType(); 9400 // Atomic types can be used for increment / decrement where the non-atomic 9401 // versions can, so ignore the _Atomic() specifier for the purpose of 9402 // checking. 9403 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 9404 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 9405 9406 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression"); 9407 9408 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) { 9409 // Decrement of bool is not allowed. 9410 if (!IsInc) { 9411 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange(); 9412 return QualType(); 9413 } 9414 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated. 9415 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange(); 9416 } else if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isEnumeralType()) { 9417 // Error on enum increments and decrements in C++ mode 9418 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_increment_decrement_enum) << IsInc << ResType; 9419 return QualType(); 9420 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) { 9421 // OK! 9422 } else if (ResType->isPointerType()) { 9423 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2 9424 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op)) 9425 return QualType(); 9426 } else if (ResType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9427 // On modern runtimes, ObjC pointer arithmetic is forbidden. 9428 // Otherwise, we just need a complete type. 9429 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, OpLoc, Op) || 9430 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(S, OpLoc, Op)) 9431 return QualType(); 9432 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) { 9433 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension. 9434 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex) 9435 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange(); 9436 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) { 9437 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 9438 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9439 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OK, OpLoc, 9440 IsInc, IsPrefix); 9441 } else if (S.getLangOpts().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) { 9442 // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 ) 9443 } else if(S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ResType->isVectorType() && 9444 ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) { 9445 // OpenCL V1.2 6.3 says dec/inc ops operate on integer vector types. 9446 } else { 9447 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement) 9448 << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange(); 9449 return QualType(); 9450 } 9451 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type. 9452 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue. 9453 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S)) 9454 return QualType(); 9455 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise 9456 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the 9457 // operand. 9458 if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9459 VK = VK_LValue; 9460 OK = Op->getObjectKind(); 9461 return ResType; 9462 } else { 9463 VK = VK_RValue; 9464 return ResType.getUnqualifiedType(); 9465 } 9466 } 9467 9468 9469 /// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand(). 9470 /// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions 9471 /// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to 9472 /// handle cases when the expression references a function designator 9473 /// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples: 9474 /// - &(x) => x 9475 /// - &*****f => f for f a function designator. 9476 /// - &s.xx => s 9477 /// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array 9478 /// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array 9479 /// - &"123"[2] -> 0 9480 /// - & __real__ x -> x 9481 static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) { 9482 switch (E->getStmtClass()) { 9483 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass: 9484 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl(); 9485 case Stmt::MemberExprClass: 9486 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from 9487 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is 9488 // irrelevant. 9489 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow()) 9490 return nullptr; 9491 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base 9492 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase()); 9493 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: { 9494 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit 9495 // promotion of register arrays earlier. 9496 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase(); 9497 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) { 9498 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType()) 9499 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr()); 9500 } 9501 return nullptr; 9502 } 9503 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: { 9504 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E); 9505 9506 switch(UO->getOpcode()) { 9507 case UO_Real: 9508 case UO_Imag: 9509 case UO_Extension: 9510 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr()); 9511 default: 9512 return nullptr; 9513 } 9514 } 9515 case Stmt::ParenExprClass: 9516 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 9517 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: 9518 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about 9519 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter. 9520 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 9521 default: 9522 return nullptr; 9523 } 9524 } 9525 9526 namespace { 9527 enum { 9528 AO_Bit_Field = 0, 9529 AO_Vector_Element = 1, 9530 AO_Property_Expansion = 2, 9531 AO_Register_Variable = 3, 9532 AO_No_Error = 4 9533 }; 9534 } 9535 /// \brief Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations. 9536 /// 9537 /// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken. 9538 static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9539 Expr *E, unsigned Type) { 9540 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange(); 9541 } 9542 9543 /// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function 9544 /// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the 9545 /// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field. 9546 /// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the & 9547 /// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue. 9548 /// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case 9549 /// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type. 9550 QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9551 if (const BuiltinType *PTy = OrigOp.get()->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()){ 9552 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 9553 Expr *E = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 9554 if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(E)) { 9555 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf); 9556 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof_addrof_function) 9557 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 9558 return QualType(); 9559 } 9560 9561 OverloadExpr *Ovl = cast<OverloadExpr>(E); 9562 if (isa<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Ovl)) 9563 if (!ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Ovl)) { 9564 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 9565 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 9566 return QualType(); 9567 } 9568 9569 return Context.OverloadTy; 9570 } 9571 9572 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny) 9573 return Context.UnknownAnyTy; 9574 9575 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember) { 9576 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 9577 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 9578 return QualType(); 9579 } 9580 9581 OrigOp = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp.get()); 9582 if (OrigOp.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9583 } 9584 9585 if (OrigOp.get()->isTypeDependent()) 9586 return Context.DependentTy; 9587 9588 assert(!OrigOp.get()->getType()->isPlaceholderType()); 9589 9590 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks 9591 Expr *op = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 9592 9593 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed. 9594 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && op->getType()->isFunctionType()) { 9595 Diag(op->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address); 9596 return QualType(); 9597 } 9598 9599 if (getLangOpts().C99) { 9600 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules. 9601 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) { 9602 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref) 9603 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result 9604 // (assuming the deref expression is valid). 9605 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType(); 9606 } 9607 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript 9608 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway. 9609 } 9610 ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op); 9611 Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(Context); 9612 unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error; 9613 9614 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary || lval == Expr::LV_ArrayTemporary) { 9615 bool sfinae = (bool)isSFINAEContext(); 9616 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_temporary 9617 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_temporary) 9618 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 9619 if (sfinae) 9620 return QualType(); 9621 // Materialize the temporary as an lvalue so that we can take its address. 9622 OrigOp = op = new (Context) 9623 MaterializeTemporaryExpr(op->getType(), OrigOp.get(), true); 9624 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) { 9625 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 9626 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) { 9627 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer. 9628 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo. 9629 9630 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up. 9631 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) { 9632 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 9633 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 9634 return QualType(); 9635 } 9636 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op); 9637 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 9638 9639 // The id-expression was parenthesized. 9640 if (OrigOp.get() != DRE) { 9641 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function) 9642 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 9643 9644 // The method was named without a qualifier. 9645 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) { 9646 if (MD->getParent()->getName().empty()) 9647 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 9648 << op->getSourceRange(); 9649 else { 9650 SmallString<32> Str; 9651 StringRef Qual = (MD->getParent()->getName() + "::").toStringRef(Str); 9652 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 9653 << op->getSourceRange() 9654 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(op->getSourceRange().getBegin(), Qual); 9655 } 9656 } 9657 9658 // Taking the address of a dtor is illegal per C++ [class.dtor]p2. 9659 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) 9660 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_addrof_dtor) << op->getSourceRange(); 9661 9662 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 9663 op->getType(), Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr()); 9664 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 9665 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0); 9666 return MPTy; 9667 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 9668 // C99 6.5.3.2p1 9669 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator 9670 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) { 9671 // Use a special diagnostic for loads from property references. 9672 if (isa<PseudoObjectExpr>(op)) { 9673 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion; 9674 } else { 9675 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof) 9676 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 9677 return QualType(); 9678 } 9679 } 9680 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 9681 // The operand cannot be a bit-field 9682 AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field; 9683 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) { 9684 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector 9685 AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element; 9686 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 9687 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared 9688 // with the register storage-class specifier. 9689 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) { 9690 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register 9691 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3) 9692 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register && 9693 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9694 AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable; 9695 } 9696 } else if (isa<MSPropertyDecl>(dcl)) { 9697 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion; 9698 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 9699 return Context.OverloadTy; 9700 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) { 9701 // Okay: we can take the address of a field. 9702 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit 9703 // scope qualifier for the class. 9704 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) { 9705 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext(); 9706 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) { 9707 if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 9708 Diag(OpLoc, 9709 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type) 9710 << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType(); 9711 return QualType(); 9712 } 9713 9714 while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 9715 Ctx = Ctx->getParent(); 9716 9717 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 9718 op->getType(), 9719 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr()); 9720 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 9721 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0); 9722 return MPTy; 9723 } 9724 } 9725 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(dcl)) 9726 llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type"); 9727 } 9728 9729 if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) { 9730 diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(*this, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError); 9731 return QualType(); 9732 } 9733 9734 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 9735 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we 9736 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid. 9737 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;". 9738 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange(); 9739 } 9740 9741 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type". 9742 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType()) 9743 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType()); 9744 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 9745 } 9746 9747 static void RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema &S, const Expr *Exp) { 9748 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Exp); 9749 if (!DRE) 9750 return; 9751 const Decl *D = DRE->getDecl(); 9752 if (!D) 9753 return; 9754 const ParmVarDecl *Param = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D); 9755 if (!Param) 9756 return; 9757 if (const FunctionDecl* FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Param->getDeclContext())) 9758 if (!FD->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>() && !Param->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>()) 9759 return; 9760 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FD = S.getCurFunction()) 9761 if (!FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.count(Param)) 9762 FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.insert(Param); 9763 } 9764 9765 /// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*'). 9766 static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK, 9767 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9768 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 9769 return S.Context.DependentTy; 9770 9771 ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op); 9772 if (ConvResult.isInvalid()) 9773 return QualType(); 9774 Op = ConvResult.get(); 9775 QualType OpTy = Op->getType(); 9776 QualType Result; 9777 9778 if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) { 9779 QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType(); 9780 S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true, 9781 Op->getSourceRange()); 9782 } 9783 9784 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 9785 Result = PT->getPointeeType(); 9786 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = 9787 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 9788 Result = OPT->getPointeeType(); 9789 else { 9790 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 9791 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9792 if (PR.get() != Op) 9793 return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc); 9794 } 9795 9796 if (Result.isNull()) { 9797 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer) 9798 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 9799 return QualType(); 9800 } 9801 9802 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if Result 9803 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about 9804 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a 9805 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes. In C++, indirection is not valid 9806 // for pointers to 'void' but is fine for any other pointer type: 9807 // 9808 // C++ [expr.unary.op]p1: 9809 // [...] the expression to which [the unary * operator] is applied shall 9810 // be a pointer to an object type, or a pointer to a function type 9811 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result->isVoidType()) 9812 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer) 9813 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 9814 9815 // Dereferences are usually l-values... 9816 VK = VK_LValue; 9817 9818 // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C. 9819 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType()) 9820 VK = VK_RValue; 9821 9822 return Result; 9823 } 9824 9825 BinaryOperatorKind Sema::ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind) { 9826 BinaryOperatorKind Opc; 9827 switch (Kind) { 9828 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!"); 9829 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break; 9830 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break; 9831 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break; 9832 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break; 9833 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break; 9834 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break; 9835 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break; 9836 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break; 9837 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break; 9838 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break; 9839 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break; 9840 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break; 9841 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break; 9842 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break; 9843 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break; 9844 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break; 9845 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break; 9846 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break; 9847 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break; 9848 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break; 9849 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break; 9850 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break; 9851 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break; 9852 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break; 9853 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break; 9854 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break; 9855 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break; 9856 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break; 9857 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break; 9858 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break; 9859 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break; 9860 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break; 9861 } 9862 return Opc; 9863 } 9864 9865 static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode( 9866 tok::TokenKind Kind) { 9867 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 9868 switch (Kind) { 9869 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 9870 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break; 9871 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break; 9872 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break; 9873 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break; 9874 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break; 9875 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break; 9876 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break; 9877 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break; 9878 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break; 9879 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break; 9880 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break; 9881 } 9882 return Opc; 9883 } 9884 9885 /// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself. 9886 /// This warning is only emitted for builtin assignment operations. It is also 9887 /// suppressed in the event of macro expansions. 9888 static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 9889 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9890 if (!S.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) 9891 return; 9892 if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID()) 9893 return; 9894 LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9895 RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9896 const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 9897 const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 9898 if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef || 9899 LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() || 9900 RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID()) 9901 return; 9902 const ValueDecl *LHSDecl = 9903 cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 9904 const ValueDecl *RHSDecl = 9905 cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 9906 if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl) 9907 return; 9908 if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 9909 return; 9910 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 9911 if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified()) 9912 return; 9913 9914 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_self_assignment) 9915 << LHSDeclRef->getType() 9916 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 9917 } 9918 9919 /// Check if a bitwise-& is performed on an Objective-C pointer. This 9920 /// is usually indicative of introspection within the Objective-C pointer. 9921 static void checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema &S, ExprResult &L, ExprResult &R, 9922 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9923 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1) 9924 return; 9925 9926 const Expr *ObjCPointerExpr = nullptr, *OtherExpr = nullptr; 9927 const Expr *LHS = L.get(); 9928 const Expr *RHS = R.get(); 9929 9930 if (LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9931 ObjCPointerExpr = LHS; 9932 OtherExpr = RHS; 9933 } 9934 else if (RHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9935 ObjCPointerExpr = RHS; 9936 OtherExpr = LHS; 9937 } 9938 9939 // This warning is deliberately made very specific to reduce false 9940 // positives with logic that uses '&' for hashing. This logic mainly 9941 // looks for code trying to introspect into tagged pointers, which 9942 // code should generally never do. 9943 if (ObjCPointerExpr && isa<IntegerLiteral>(OtherExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 9944 unsigned Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking; 9945 // Determine if we are introspecting the result of performSelectorXXX. 9946 const Expr *Ex = ObjCPointerExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 9947 // Special case messages to -performSelector and friends, which 9948 // can return non-pointer values boxed in a pointer value. 9949 // Some clients may wish to silence warnings in this subcase. 9950 if (const ObjCMessageExpr *ME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Ex)) { 9951 Selector S = ME->getSelector(); 9952 StringRef SelArg0 = S.getNameForSlot(0); 9953 if (SelArg0.startswith("performSelector")) 9954 Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking_performSelector; 9955 } 9956 9957 S.Diag(OpLoc, Diag) 9958 << ObjCPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 9959 } 9960 } 9961 9962 static NamedDecl *getDeclFromExpr(Expr *E) { 9963 if (!E) 9964 return nullptr; 9965 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 9966 return DRE->getDecl(); 9967 if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) 9968 return ME->getMemberDecl(); 9969 if (auto *IRE = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) 9970 return IRE->getDecl(); 9971 return nullptr; 9972 } 9973 9974 /// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with 9975 /// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports 9976 /// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators. 9977 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 9978 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9979 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9980 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isa<InitListExpr>(RHSExpr)) { 9981 // The syntax only allows initializer lists on the RHS of assignment, 9982 // so we don't need to worry about accepting invalid code for 9983 // non-assignment operators. 9984 // C++11 5.17p9: 9985 // The meaning of x = {v} [...] is that of x = T(v) [...]. The meaning 9986 // of x = {} is x = T(). 9987 InitializationKind Kind = 9988 InitializationKind::CreateDirectList(RHSExpr->getLocStart()); 9989 InitializedEntity Entity = 9990 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(LHSExpr->getType()); 9991 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 9992 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 9993 if (Init.isInvalid()) 9994 return Init; 9995 RHSExpr = Init.get(); 9996 } 9997 9998 ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 9999 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator. 10000 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators 10001 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation 10002 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result 10003 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 10004 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 10005 10006 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10007 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it 10008 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 10009 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 10010 LHS = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHSExpr); 10011 RHS = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHSExpr, [Opc, LHS](Expr *E) { 10012 if (Opc != BO_Assign) 10013 return ExprResult(E); 10014 // Avoid correcting the RHS to the same Expr as the LHS. 10015 Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(E); 10016 return (D && D == getDeclFromExpr(LHS.get())) ? ExprError() : E; 10017 }); 10018 if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable()) 10019 return ExprError(); 10020 } 10021 10022 switch (Opc) { 10023 case BO_Assign: 10024 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType()); 10025 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 10026 LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) { 10027 VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind(); 10028 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 10029 } 10030 if (!ResultTy.isNull()) { 10031 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc); 10032 DiagnoseSelfMove(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc); 10033 } 10034 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, LHS.get()); 10035 break; 10036 case BO_PtrMemD: 10037 case BO_PtrMemI: 10038 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc, 10039 Opc == BO_PtrMemI); 10040 break; 10041 case BO_Mul: 10042 case BO_Div: 10043 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false, 10044 Opc == BO_Div); 10045 break; 10046 case BO_Rem: 10047 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 10048 break; 10049 case BO_Add: 10050 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 10051 break; 10052 case BO_Sub: 10053 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 10054 break; 10055 case BO_Shl: 10056 case BO_Shr: 10057 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 10058 break; 10059 case BO_LE: 10060 case BO_LT: 10061 case BO_GE: 10062 case BO_GT: 10063 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true); 10064 break; 10065 case BO_EQ: 10066 case BO_NE: 10067 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, false); 10068 break; 10069 case BO_And: 10070 checkObjCPointerIntrospection(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 10071 case BO_Xor: 10072 case BO_Or: 10073 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 10074 break; 10075 case BO_LAnd: 10076 case BO_LOr: 10077 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 10078 break; 10079 case BO_MulAssign: 10080 case BO_DivAssign: 10081 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true, 10082 Opc == BO_DivAssign); 10083 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 10084 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 10085 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 10086 break; 10087 case BO_RemAssign: 10088 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true); 10089 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 10090 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 10091 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 10092 break; 10093 case BO_AddAssign: 10094 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, &CompLHSTy); 10095 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 10096 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 10097 break; 10098 case BO_SubAssign: 10099 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy); 10100 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 10101 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 10102 break; 10103 case BO_ShlAssign: 10104 case BO_ShrAssign: 10105 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true); 10106 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 10107 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 10108 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 10109 break; 10110 case BO_AndAssign: 10111 case BO_OrAssign: // fallthrough 10112 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc); 10113 case BO_XorAssign: 10114 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true); 10115 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 10116 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 10117 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 10118 break; 10119 case BO_Comma: 10120 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 10121 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) { 10122 VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind(); 10123 OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 10124 } 10125 break; 10126 } 10127 if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 10128 return ExprError(); 10129 10130 // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator 10131 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get()); 10132 CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get()); 10133 10134 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 10135 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 10136 &Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 10137 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 10138 if (ObjectSetClass && isa<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get())) { 10139 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd()); 10140 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) << 10141 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS.get()->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") << 10142 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OpLoc), ",") << 10143 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 10144 } 10145 else 10146 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 10147 } 10148 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 10149 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) 10150 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, OpLoc, RHS.get()); 10151 10152 if (CompResultTy.isNull()) 10153 return new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, 10154 OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract); 10155 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != 10156 OK_ObjCProperty) { 10157 VK = VK_LValue; 10158 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 10159 } 10160 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 10161 LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, CompLHSTy, CompResultTy, 10162 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract); 10163 } 10164 10165 /// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison 10166 /// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that 10167 /// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of 10168 /// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1". 10169 static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 10170 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 10171 Expr *RHSExpr) { 10172 BinaryOperator *LHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr); 10173 BinaryOperator *RHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr); 10174 10175 // Check that one of the sides is a comparison operator. 10176 bool isLeftComp = LHSBO && LHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 10177 bool isRightComp = RHSBO && RHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 10178 if (!isLeftComp && !isRightComp) 10179 return; 10180 10181 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops. 10182 // Don't diagnose this. 10183 bool isLeftBitwise = LHSBO && LHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 10184 bool isRightBitwise = RHSBO && RHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 10185 if ((isLeftComp || isLeftBitwise) && (isRightComp || isRightBitwise)) 10186 return; 10187 10188 SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), 10189 OpLoc) 10190 : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 10191 StringRef OpStr = isLeftComp ? LHSBO->getOpcodeStr() : RHSBO->getOpcodeStr(); 10192 SourceRange ParensRange = isLeftComp ? 10193 SourceRange(LHSBO->getRHS()->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()) 10194 : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSBO->getLHS()->getLocEnd()); 10195 10196 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel) 10197 << DiagRange << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr; 10198 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 10199 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << OpStr, 10200 (isLeftComp ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr)->getSourceRange()); 10201 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 10202 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first) 10203 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 10204 ParensRange); 10205 } 10206 10207 /// \brief It accepts a '&' expr that is inside a '|' one. 10208 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&' expression 10209 /// in parentheses. 10210 static void 10211 EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10212 BinaryOperator *Bop) { 10213 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And); 10214 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_and_in_bitwise_or) 10215 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 10216 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 10217 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 10218 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 10219 Bop->getSourceRange()); 10220 } 10221 10222 /// \brief It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one. 10223 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression 10224 /// in parentheses. 10225 static void 10226 EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10227 BinaryOperator *Bop) { 10228 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd); 10229 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or) 10230 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 10231 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 10232 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 10233 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 10234 Bop->getSourceRange()); 10235 } 10236 10237 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 10238 /// 'true'. 10239 static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 10240 bool Res; 10241 return !E->isValueDependent() && 10242 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res; 10243 } 10244 10245 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 10246 /// 'false'. 10247 static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 10248 bool Res; 10249 return !E->isValueDependent() && 10250 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res; 10251 } 10252 10253 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr. 10254 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10255 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 10256 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) { 10257 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 10258 // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 10259 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, RHSExpr)) 10260 return; 10261 // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 10262 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS())) 10263 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 10264 } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) { 10265 if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) { 10266 // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for 10267 // "a || b && 1", but warn now. 10268 if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS())) 10269 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop); 10270 } 10271 } 10272 } 10273 } 10274 10275 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr. 10276 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10277 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 10278 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) { 10279 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 10280 // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 10281 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, LHSExpr)) 10282 return; 10283 // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 10284 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS())) 10285 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 10286 } 10287 } 10288 } 10289 10290 /// \brief Look for '&' in the left or right hand of a '|' expr. 10291 static void DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10292 Expr *OrArg) { 10293 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(OrArg)) { 10294 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And) 10295 return EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 10296 } 10297 } 10298 10299 static void DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10300 Expr *SubExpr, StringRef Shift) { 10301 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) { 10302 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Add || Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Sub) { 10303 StringRef Op = Bop->getOpcodeStr(); 10304 S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_addition_in_bitshift) 10305 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc << Shift << Op; 10306 SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 10307 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << Op, 10308 Bop->getSourceRange()); 10309 } 10310 } 10311 } 10312 10313 static void DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10314 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 10315 CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(LHSExpr); 10316 if (!OCE) 10317 return; 10318 10319 FunctionDecl *FD = OCE->getDirectCallee(); 10320 if (!FD || !FD->isOverloadedOperator()) 10321 return; 10322 10323 OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = FD->getOverloadedOperator(); 10324 if (Kind != OO_LessLess && Kind != OO_GreaterGreater) 10325 return; 10326 10327 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_overloaded_shift_in_comparison) 10328 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange() 10329 << (Kind == OO_LessLess); 10330 SuggestParentheses(S, OCE->getOperatorLoc(), 10331 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 10332 << (Kind == OO_LessLess ? "<<" : ">>"), 10333 OCE->getSourceRange()); 10334 SuggestParentheses(S, OpLoc, 10335 S.PDiag(diag::note_evaluate_comparison_first), 10336 SourceRange(OCE->getArg(1)->getLocStart(), 10337 RHSExpr->getLocEnd())); 10338 } 10339 10340 /// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky 10341 /// precedence. 10342 static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 10343 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 10344 Expr *RHSExpr){ 10345 // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3". 10346 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc)) 10347 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10348 10349 // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3" 10350 if (Opc == BO_Or && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 10351 DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr); 10352 DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr); 10353 } 10354 10355 // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does. 10356 // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe. 10357 if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 10358 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10359 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10360 } 10361 10362 if ((Opc == BO_Shl && LHSExpr->getType()->isIntegralType(Self.getASTContext())) 10363 || Opc == BO_Shr) { 10364 StringRef Shift = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc); 10365 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, Shift); 10366 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr, Shift); 10367 } 10368 10369 // Warn on overloaded shift operators and comparisons, such as: 10370 // cout << 5 == 4; 10371 if (BinaryOperator::isComparisonOp(Opc)) 10372 DiagnoseShiftCompare(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10373 } 10374 10375 // Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 10376 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 10377 tok::TokenKind Kind, 10378 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 10379 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind); 10380 assert(LHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression"); 10381 assert(RHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression"); 10382 10383 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0" 10384 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10385 10386 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10387 } 10388 10389 /// Build an overloaded binary operator expression in the given scope. 10390 static ExprResult BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema &S, Scope *Sc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10391 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 10392 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 10393 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 10394 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 10395 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 10396 // the arguments. 10397 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 10398 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp 10399 = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 10400 if (Sc && OverOp != OO_None && OverOp != OO_Equal) 10401 S.LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, Sc, LHS->getType(), 10402 RHS->getType(), Functions); 10403 10404 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent) 10405 // binary operation. 10406 return S.CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHS, RHS); 10407 } 10408 10409 ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10410 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 10411 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 10412 // We want to end up calling one of checkPseudoObjectAssignment 10413 // (if the LHS is a pseudo-object), BuildOverloadedBinOp (if 10414 // both expressions are overloadable or either is type-dependent), 10415 // or CreateBuiltinBinOp (in any other case). We also want to get 10416 // any placeholder types out of the way. 10417 10418 // Handle pseudo-objects in the LHS. 10419 if (const BuiltinType *pty = LHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 10420 // Assignments with a pseudo-object l-value need special analysis. 10421 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 10422 BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) 10423 return checkPseudoObjectAssignment(S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10424 10425 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 10426 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 10427 // We can't actually test that if we still have a placeholder, 10428 // though. Fortunately, none of the exceptions we see in that 10429 // code below are valid when the LHS is an overload set. Note 10430 // that an overload set can be dependently-typed, but it never 10431 // instantiates to having an overloadable type. 10432 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 10433 if (resolvedRHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10434 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 10435 10436 if (RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || 10437 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 10438 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10439 } 10440 10441 ExprResult LHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHSExpr); 10442 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10443 LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 10444 } 10445 10446 // Handle pseudo-objects in the RHS. 10447 if (const BuiltinType *pty = RHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 10448 // An overload in the RHS can potentially be resolved by the type 10449 // being assigned to. 10450 if (Opc == BO_Assign && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 10451 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent()) 10452 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10453 10454 if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 10455 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10456 10457 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10458 } 10459 10460 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 10461 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload && 10462 LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 10463 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10464 10465 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 10466 if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 10467 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 10468 } 10469 10470 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10471 // If either expression is type-dependent, always build an 10472 // overloaded op. 10473 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent()) 10474 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10475 10476 // Otherwise, build an overloaded op if either expression has an 10477 // overloadable type. 10478 if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() || 10479 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 10480 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10481 } 10482 10483 // Build a built-in binary operation. 10484 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10485 } 10486 10487 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 10488 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 10489 Expr *InputExpr) { 10490 ExprResult Input = InputExpr; 10491 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 10492 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 10493 QualType resultType; 10494 switch (Opc) { 10495 case UO_PreInc: 10496 case UO_PreDec: 10497 case UO_PostInc: 10498 case UO_PostDec: 10499 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OK, 10500 OpLoc, 10501 Opc == UO_PreInc || 10502 Opc == UO_PostInc, 10503 Opc == UO_PreInc || 10504 Opc == UO_PreDec); 10505 break; 10506 case UO_AddrOf: 10507 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc); 10508 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, InputExpr); 10509 break; 10510 case UO_Deref: { 10511 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 10512 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10513 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc); 10514 break; 10515 } 10516 case UO_Plus: 10517 case UO_Minus: 10518 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 10519 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10520 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 10521 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 10522 break; 10523 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1 10524 resultType->isVectorType()) 10525 break; 10526 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6 10527 Opc == UO_Plus && 10528 resultType->isPointerType()) 10529 break; 10530 10531 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10532 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10533 10534 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement 10535 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 10536 if (Input.isInvalid()) 10537 return ExprError(); 10538 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 10539 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 10540 break; 10541 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension. 10542 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType()) 10543 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation. 10544 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex) 10545 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange(); 10546 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 10547 break; 10548 else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) { 10549 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 10550 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.f: The bitwise operator not (~) does not operate 10551 // on vector float types. 10552 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 10553 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 10554 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10555 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10556 } 10557 break; 10558 } else { 10559 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10560 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10561 } 10562 break; 10563 10564 case UO_LNot: // logical negation 10565 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5). 10566 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 10567 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10568 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 10569 10570 // Though we still have to promote half FP to float... 10571 if (resultType->isHalfType() && !Context.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) { 10572 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 10573 resultType = Context.FloatTy; 10574 } 10575 10576 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 10577 break; 10578 if (resultType->isScalarType() && !isScopedEnumerationType(resultType)) { 10579 // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough; 10580 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10581 // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9: 10582 // operand contextually converted to bool. 10583 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.BoolTy, 10584 ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType)); 10585 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 10586 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 10587 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 10588 // operate on scalar float types. 10589 if (!resultType->isIntegerType()) 10590 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10591 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10592 } 10593 } else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) { 10594 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 10595 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 10596 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 10597 // operate on vector float types. 10598 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 10599 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 10600 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10601 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10602 } 10603 // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type. 10604 resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType); 10605 break; 10606 } else { 10607 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10608 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10609 } 10610 10611 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5. 10612 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8 10613 resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 10614 break; 10615 case UO_Real: 10616 case UO_Imag: 10617 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real); 10618 // _Real maps ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values. _Imag maps ordinary 10619 // complex l-values to ordinary l-values and all other values to r-values. 10620 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10621 if (Opc == UO_Real || Input.get()->getType()->isAnyComplexType()) { 10622 if (Input.get()->getValueKind() != VK_RValue && 10623 Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary) 10624 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 10625 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10626 // In C, a volatile scalar is read by __imag. In C++, it is not. 10627 Input = DefaultLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 10628 } 10629 break; 10630 case UO_Extension: 10631 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 10632 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 10633 OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind(); 10634 break; 10635 } 10636 if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid()) 10637 return ExprError(); 10638 10639 // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator, 10640 // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially 10641 // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize] 10642 // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard). 10643 if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref) 10644 CheckArrayAccess(Input.get()); 10645 10646 return new (Context) 10647 UnaryOperator(Input.get(), Opc, resultType, VK, OK, OpLoc); 10648 } 10649 10650 /// \brief Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member 10651 /// access expression, of a form that could be turned into a pointer to member 10652 /// with the address-of operator. 10653 static bool isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E) { 10654 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 10655 if (!DRE->getQualifier()) 10656 return false; 10657 10658 ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl(); 10659 if (!VD->isCXXClassMember()) 10660 return false; 10661 10662 if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 10663 return true; 10664 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)) 10665 return Method->isInstance(); 10666 10667 return false; 10668 } 10669 10670 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 10671 if (!ULE->getQualifier()) 10672 return false; 10673 10674 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator D = ULE->decls_begin(), 10675 DEnd = ULE->decls_end(); 10676 D != DEnd; ++D) { 10677 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(*D)) { 10678 if (Method->isInstance()) 10679 return true; 10680 } else { 10681 // Overload set does not contain methods. 10682 break; 10683 } 10684 } 10685 10686 return false; 10687 } 10688 10689 return false; 10690 } 10691 10692 ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10693 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input) { 10694 // First things first: handle placeholders so that the 10695 // overloaded-operator check considers the right type. 10696 if (const BuiltinType *pty = Input->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 10697 // Increment and decrement of pseudo-object references. 10698 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 10699 UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc)) 10700 return checkPseudoObjectIncDec(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10701 10702 // extension is always a builtin operator. 10703 if (Opc == UO_Extension) 10704 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10705 10706 // & gets special logic for several kinds of placeholder. 10707 // The builtin code knows what to do. 10708 if (Opc == UO_AddrOf && 10709 (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload || 10710 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny || 10711 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember)) 10712 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10713 10714 // Anything else needs to be handled now. 10715 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input); 10716 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10717 Input = Result.get(); 10718 } 10719 10720 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() && 10721 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None && 10722 !(Opc == UO_AddrOf && isQualifiedMemberAccess(Input))) { 10723 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 10724 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 10725 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 10726 // the arguments. 10727 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 10728 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 10729 if (S && OverOp != OO_None) 10730 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(), 10731 Functions); 10732 10733 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input); 10734 } 10735 10736 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10737 } 10738 10739 // Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 10740 ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10741 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) { 10742 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input); 10743 } 10744 10745 /// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo". 10746 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc, 10747 LabelDecl *TheDecl) { 10748 TheDecl->markUsed(Context); 10749 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'. 10750 return new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl, 10751 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)); 10752 } 10753 10754 /// Given the last statement in a statement-expression, check whether 10755 /// the result is a producing expression (like a call to an 10756 /// ns_returns_retained function) and, if so, rebuild it to hoist the 10757 /// release out of the full-expression. Otherwise, return null. 10758 /// Cannot fail. 10759 static Expr *maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(Stmt *Statement) { 10760 // Should always be wrapped with one of these. 10761 ExprWithCleanups *cleanups = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Statement); 10762 if (!cleanups) return nullptr; 10763 10764 ImplicitCastExpr *cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(cleanups->getSubExpr()); 10765 if (!cast || cast->getCastKind() != CK_ARCConsumeObject) 10766 return nullptr; 10767 10768 // Splice out the cast. This shouldn't modify any interesting 10769 // features of the statement. 10770 Expr *producer = cast->getSubExpr(); 10771 assert(producer->getType() == cast->getType()); 10772 assert(producer->getValueKind() == cast->getValueKind()); 10773 cleanups->setSubExpr(producer); 10774 return cleanups; 10775 } 10776 10777 void Sema::ActOnStartStmtExpr() { 10778 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 10779 } 10780 10781 void Sema::ActOnStmtExprError() { 10782 // Note that function is also called by TreeTransform when leaving a 10783 // StmtExpr scope without rebuilding anything. 10784 10785 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10786 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 10787 } 10788 10789 ExprResult 10790 Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt, 10791 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})" 10792 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!"); 10793 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt); 10794 10795 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 10796 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10797 assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within StmtExpr not correctly bound!"); 10798 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 10799 10800 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for 10801 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently. 10802 // More semantic analysis is needed. 10803 10804 // If there are sub-stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one 10805 // as the type of the stmtexpr. 10806 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy; 10807 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false; 10808 if (!Compound->body_empty()) { 10809 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back(); 10810 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = nullptr; 10811 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body. 10812 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) { 10813 LastLabelStmt = Label; 10814 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt(); 10815 } 10816 10817 if (Expr *LastE = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) { 10818 // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not 10819 // lvalue-to-rvalue. However, initialize an unqualified type. 10820 ExprResult LastExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(LastE); 10821 if (LastExpr.isInvalid()) 10822 return ExprError(); 10823 Ty = LastExpr.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 10824 10825 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr.get()->isTypeDependent()) { 10826 // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice 10827 // the consume out and bind it later. In the alternate case 10828 // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result 10829 // initialization will create a produce. In both cases the 10830 // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with 10831 // a bind. 10832 if (Expr *rebuiltLastStmt 10833 = maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(LastExpr.get())) { 10834 LastExpr = rebuiltLastStmt; 10835 } else { 10836 LastExpr = PerformCopyInitialization( 10837 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc, 10838 Ty, 10839 false), 10840 SourceLocation(), 10841 LastExpr); 10842 } 10843 10844 if (LastExpr.isInvalid()) 10845 return ExprError(); 10846 if (LastExpr.get() != nullptr) { 10847 if (!LastLabelStmt) 10848 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr.get()); 10849 else 10850 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr.get()); 10851 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true; 10852 } 10853 } 10854 } 10855 } 10856 10857 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement 10858 // expressions are not lvalues. 10859 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc); 10860 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp) 10861 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr); 10862 return ResStmtExpr; 10863 } 10864 10865 ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 10866 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 10867 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr, 10868 unsigned NumComponents, 10869 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 10870 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType(); 10871 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType(); 10872 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange(); 10873 10874 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first 10875 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents 10876 // a struct/union/class. 10877 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType()) 10878 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 10879 << ArgTy << TypeRange); 10880 10881 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable 10882 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed. 10883 if (!Dependent 10884 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy, 10885 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type, TypeRange)) 10886 return ExprError(); 10887 10888 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a 10889 // GCC extension, diagnose them. 10890 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in 10891 // a system header! 10892 if (NumComponents != 1) 10893 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator) 10894 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd); 10895 10896 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false; 10897 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy; 10898 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode; 10899 SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps; 10900 SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs; 10901 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) { 10902 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i]; 10903 if (OC.isBrackets) { 10904 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements? 10905 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 10906 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType); 10907 if(!AT) 10908 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type) 10909 << CurrentType); 10910 CurrentType = AT->getElementType(); 10911 } else 10912 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 10913 10914 ExprResult IdxRval = DefaultLvalueConversion(static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E)); 10915 if (IdxRval.isInvalid()) 10916 return ExprError(); 10917 Expr *Idx = IdxRval.get(); 10918 10919 // The expression must be an integral expression. 10920 // FIXME: An integral constant expression? 10921 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() && 10922 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType()) 10923 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(), 10924 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 10925 << Idx->getSourceRange()); 10926 10927 // Record this array index. 10928 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd)); 10929 Exprs.push_back(Idx); 10930 continue; 10931 } 10932 10933 // Offset of a field. 10934 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 10935 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent 10936 // type. Just record the identifier of the field. 10937 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd)); 10938 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 10939 continue; 10940 } 10941 10942 // We need to have a complete type to look into. 10943 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType, 10944 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)) 10945 return ExprError(); 10946 10947 // Look for the designated field. 10948 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>(); 10949 if (!RC) 10950 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 10951 << CurrentType); 10952 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl(); 10953 10954 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5: 10955 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this 10956 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union 10957 // (clause 9). 10958 // C++11 [support.types]p4: 10959 // If type is not a standard-layout class (Clause 9), the results are 10960 // undefined. 10961 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 10962 bool IsSafe = LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? CRD->isStandardLayout() : CRD->isPOD(); 10963 unsigned DiagID = 10964 LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? diag::ext_offsetof_non_standardlayout_type 10965 : diag::ext_offsetof_non_pod_type; 10966 10967 if (!IsSafe && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD && 10968 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc, nullptr, 10969 PDiag(DiagID) 10970 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd) 10971 << CurrentType)) 10972 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true; 10973 } 10974 10975 // Look for the field. 10976 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName); 10977 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD); 10978 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>(); 10979 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = nullptr; 10980 if (!MemberDecl) { 10981 if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>())) 10982 MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField(); 10983 } 10984 10985 if (!MemberDecl) 10986 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member) 10987 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, 10988 OC.LocEnd)); 10989 10990 // C99 7.17p3: 10991 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.) 10992 // 10993 // We diagnose this as an error. 10994 if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) { 10995 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield) 10996 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 10997 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 10998 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl); 10999 return ExprError(); 11000 } 11001 11002 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent(); 11003 if (IndirectMemberDecl) 11004 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext()); 11005 11006 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for 11007 // the base class indirections. 11008 CXXBasePaths Paths; 11009 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) { 11010 if (Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 11011 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_field_of_virtual_base) 11012 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 11013 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 11014 return ExprError(); 11015 } 11016 11017 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front(); 11018 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end(); 11019 B != BEnd; ++B) 11020 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base)); 11021 } 11022 11023 if (IndirectMemberDecl) { 11024 for (auto *FI : IndirectMemberDecl->chain()) { 11025 assert(isa<FieldDecl>(FI)); 11026 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, 11027 cast<FieldDecl>(FI), OC.LocEnd)); 11028 } 11029 } else 11030 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd)); 11031 11032 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType(); 11033 } 11034 11035 return OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc, TInfo, 11036 Comps, Exprs, RParenLoc); 11037 } 11038 11039 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S, 11040 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 11041 SourceLocation TypeLoc, 11042 ParsedType ParsedArgTy, 11043 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr, 11044 unsigned NumComponents, 11045 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 11046 11047 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo; 11048 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo); 11049 if (ArgTy.isNull()) 11050 return ExprError(); 11051 11052 if (!ArgTInfo) 11053 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc); 11054 11055 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents, 11056 RParenLoc); 11057 } 11058 11059 11060 ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 11061 Expr *CondExpr, 11062 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 11063 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 11064 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)"); 11065 11066 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 11067 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 11068 QualType resType; 11069 bool ValueDependent = false; 11070 bool CondIsTrue = false; 11071 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) { 11072 resType = Context.DependentTy; 11073 ValueDependent = true; 11074 } else { 11075 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression. 11076 llvm::APSInt condEval(32); 11077 ExprResult CondICE 11078 = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(CondExpr, &condEval, 11079 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant, false); 11080 if (CondICE.isInvalid()) 11081 return ExprError(); 11082 CondExpr = CondICE.get(); 11083 CondIsTrue = condEval.getZExtValue(); 11084 11085 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr. 11086 Expr *ActiveExpr = CondIsTrue ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr; 11087 11088 resType = ActiveExpr->getType(); 11089 ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent(); 11090 VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind(); 11091 OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind(); 11092 } 11093 11094 return new (Context) 11095 ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, resType, VK, OK, RPLoc, 11096 CondIsTrue, resType->isDependentType(), ValueDependent); 11097 } 11098 11099 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 11100 // Clang Extensions. 11101 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 11102 11103 /// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started. 11104 void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 11105 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc); 11106 11107 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) { 11108 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 11109 if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx = 11110 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Block->getDeclContext(), 11111 ManglingContextDecl)) { 11112 unsigned ManglingNumber = MCtx->getManglingNumber(Block); 11113 Block->setBlockMangling(ManglingNumber, ManglingContextDecl); 11114 } 11115 } 11116 11117 PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block); 11118 CurContext->addDecl(Block); 11119 if (CurScope) 11120 PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block); 11121 else 11122 CurContext = Block; 11123 11124 getCurBlock()->HasImplicitReturnType = true; 11125 11126 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the block from any 11127 // cleanups from the enclosing full-expression. 11128 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(PotentiallyEvaluated); 11129 } 11130 11131 void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo, 11132 Scope *CurScope) { 11133 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier() == nullptr && 11134 "block-id should have no identifier!"); 11135 assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == Declarator::BlockLiteralContext); 11136 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock(); 11137 11138 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope); 11139 QualType T = Sig->getType(); 11140 11141 // FIXME: We should allow unexpanded parameter packs here, but that would, 11142 // in turn, make the block expression contain unexpanded parameter packs. 11143 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(CaretLoc, Sig, UPPC_Block)) { 11144 // Drop the parameters. 11145 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 11146 EPI.HasTrailingReturn = false; 11147 EPI.TypeQuals |= DeclSpec::TQ_const; 11148 T = Context.getFunctionType(Context.DependentTy, None, EPI); 11149 Sig = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 11150 } 11151 11152 // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block 11153 // literal signature. Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType 11154 // unless the function was written with a typedef. 11155 assert(T->isFunctionType() && 11156 "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature"); 11157 11158 // Look for an explicit signature in that function type. 11159 FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature; 11160 11161 TypeLoc tmp = Sig->getTypeLoc().IgnoreParens(); 11162 if ((ExplicitSignature = tmp.getAs<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>())) { 11163 11164 // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by 11165 // GetTypeForDeclarator. If so, don't save that as part of the 11166 // written signature. 11167 if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() == 11168 ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) { 11169 // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of 11170 // TypeSourceInfos. 11171 TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getReturnLoc(); 11172 unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize(); 11173 Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size); 11174 Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size); 11175 11176 ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc(); 11177 } 11178 } 11179 11180 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig); 11181 CurBlock->FunctionType = T; 11182 11183 const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>(); 11184 QualType RetTy = Fn->getReturnType(); 11185 bool isVariadic = 11186 (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic()); 11187 11188 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic); 11189 11190 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block 11191 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like: 11192 // ^ * { ... } 11193 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction".... 11194 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy) { 11195 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy; 11196 CurBlock->TheDecl->setBlockMissingReturnType(false); 11197 CurBlock->HasImplicitReturnType = false; 11198 } 11199 11200 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them. 11201 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params; 11202 if (ExplicitSignature) { 11203 for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumParams(); I != E; ++I) { 11204 ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getParam(I); 11205 if (Param->getIdentifier() == nullptr && 11206 !Param->isImplicit() && 11207 !Param->isInvalidDecl() && 11208 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 11209 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted); 11210 Params.push_back(Param); 11211 } 11212 11213 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like 11214 // ^ fntype { ... } 11215 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 11216 for (const auto &I : Fn->param_types()) { 11217 ParmVarDecl *Param = BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef( 11218 CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo.getLocStart(), I); 11219 Params.push_back(Param); 11220 } 11221 } 11222 11223 // Set the parameters on the block decl. 11224 if (!Params.empty()) { 11225 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params); 11226 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(), 11227 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(), 11228 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false); 11229 } 11230 11231 // Finally we can process decl attributes. 11232 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo); 11233 11234 // Put the parameter variables in scope. 11235 for (auto AI : CurBlock->TheDecl->params()) { 11236 AI->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl); 11237 11238 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 11239 if (AI->getIdentifier()) { 11240 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, AI); 11241 11242 PushOnScopeChains(AI, CurBlock->TheScope); 11243 } 11244 } 11245 } 11246 11247 /// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback 11248 /// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl. 11249 void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 11250 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 11251 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 11252 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 11253 11254 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks. 11255 PopDeclContext(); 11256 PopFunctionScopeInfo(); 11257 } 11258 11259 /// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement 11260 /// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...} 11261 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc, 11262 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) { 11263 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error. 11264 if (!LangOpts.Blocks) 11265 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable); 11266 11267 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 11268 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 11269 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 11270 assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within block not correctly bound!"); 11271 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 11272 11273 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back()); 11274 11275 if (BSI->HasImplicitReturnType) 11276 deduceClosureReturnType(*BSI); 11277 11278 PopDeclContext(); 11279 11280 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy; 11281 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull()) 11282 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType; 11283 11284 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->hasAttr<NoReturnAttr>(); 11285 QualType BlockTy; 11286 11287 // Set the captured variables on the block. 11288 // FIXME: Share capture structure between BlockDecl and CapturingScopeInfo! 11289 SmallVector<BlockDecl::Capture, 4> Captures; 11290 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Captures.size(); i != e; i++) { 11291 CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = BSI->Captures[i]; 11292 if (Cap.isThisCapture()) 11293 continue; 11294 BlockDecl::Capture NewCap(Cap.getVariable(), Cap.isBlockCapture(), 11295 Cap.isNested(), Cap.getInitExpr()); 11296 Captures.push_back(NewCap); 11297 } 11298 BSI->TheDecl->setCaptures(Context, Captures.begin(), Captures.end(), 11299 BSI->CXXThisCaptureIndex != 0); 11300 11301 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that. 11302 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) { 11303 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 11304 11305 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo(); 11306 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true); 11307 11308 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types. 11309 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) { 11310 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 11311 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 11312 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 11313 11314 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type, 11315 // preserve its sugar structure. 11316 } else if (FTy->getReturnType() == RetTy && 11317 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) { 11318 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType; 11319 11320 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type. 11321 } else { 11322 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy); 11323 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 11324 EPI.TypeQuals = 0; // FIXME: silently? 11325 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 11326 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI); 11327 } 11328 11329 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing. 11330 } else { 11331 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 11332 EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn); 11333 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 11334 } 11335 11336 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(), 11337 BSI->TheDecl->param_end()); 11338 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy); 11339 11340 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block. 11341 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && 11342 !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 11343 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 11344 11345 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 11346 11347 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check again 11348 // if we can do this, though, because blocks keep return statements around 11349 // to deduce an implicit return type. 11350 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RetTy->isRecordType() && 11351 !BSI->TheDecl->isDependentContext()) 11352 computeNRVO(Body, BSI); 11353 11354 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy); 11355 AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 11356 PopFunctionScopeInfo(&WP, Result->getBlockDecl(), Result); 11357 11358 // If the block isn't obviously global, i.e. it captures anything at 11359 // all, then we need to do a few things in the surrounding context: 11360 if (Result->getBlockDecl()->hasCaptures()) { 11361 // First, this expression has a new cleanup object. 11362 ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(Result->getBlockDecl()); 11363 ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 11364 11365 // It also gets a branch-protected scope if any of the captured 11366 // variables needs destruction. 11367 for (const auto &CI : Result->getBlockDecl()->captures()) { 11368 const VarDecl *var = CI.getVariable(); 11369 if (var->getType().isDestructedType() != QualType::DK_none) { 11370 getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope(); 11371 break; 11372 } 11373 } 11374 } 11375 11376 return Result; 11377 } 11378 11379 ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 11380 Expr *E, ParsedType Ty, 11381 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 11382 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 11383 GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 11384 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc); 11385 } 11386 11387 ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 11388 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 11389 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 11390 Expr *OrigExpr = E; 11391 11392 // Get the va_list type 11393 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType(); 11394 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) { 11395 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64, 11396 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to 11397 // a pointer for va_arg. 11398 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType); 11399 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately. 11400 ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 11401 if (Result.isInvalid()) 11402 return ExprError(); 11403 E = Result.get(); 11404 } else if (VaListType->isRecordType() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11405 // If va_list is a record type and we are compiling in C++ mode, 11406 // check the argument using reference binding. 11407 InitializedEntity Entity 11408 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 11409 Context.getLValueReferenceType(VaListType), false); 11410 ExprResult Init = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), E); 11411 if (Init.isInvalid()) 11412 return ExprError(); 11413 E = Init.getAs<Expr>(); 11414 } else { 11415 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because 11416 // it is modified by va_arg. 11417 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && 11418 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this)) 11419 return ExprError(); 11420 } 11421 11422 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && 11423 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) { 11424 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(), 11425 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list) 11426 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange()); 11427 } 11428 11429 if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) { 11430 if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(), 11431 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete, 11432 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 11433 return ExprError(); 11434 11435 if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 11436 TInfo->getType(), 11437 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract, 11438 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 11439 return ExprError(); 11440 11441 if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) { 11442 Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 11443 TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType() 11444 ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified 11445 : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod) 11446 << TInfo->getType() 11447 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 11448 } 11449 11450 // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted 11451 // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior). 11452 QualType PromoteType; 11453 if (TInfo->getType()->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 11454 PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType()); 11455 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, TInfo->getType())) 11456 PromoteType = QualType(); 11457 } 11458 if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float)) 11459 PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy; 11460 if (!PromoteType.isNull()) 11461 DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E, 11462 PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible) 11463 << TInfo->getType() 11464 << PromoteType 11465 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()); 11466 } 11467 11468 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context); 11469 return new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T); 11470 } 11471 11472 ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) { 11473 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of 11474 // pointers on the target. 11475 QualType Ty; 11476 unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0); 11477 if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth()) 11478 Ty = Context.IntTy; 11479 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth()) 11480 Ty = Context.LongTy; 11481 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth()) 11482 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 11483 else { 11484 llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!"); 11485 } 11486 11487 return new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc); 11488 } 11489 11490 bool 11491 Sema::ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(QualType DstType, Expr *&Exp) { 11492 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) 11493 return false; 11494 11495 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 11496 if (!PT) 11497 return false; 11498 11499 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) { 11500 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface. 11501 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl(); 11502 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString")) 11503 return false; 11504 } 11505 11506 // Ignore any parens, implicit casts (should only be 11507 // array-to-pointer decays), and not-so-opaque values. The last is 11508 // important for making this trigger for property assignments. 11509 Expr *SrcExpr = Exp->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11510 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OV = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(SrcExpr)) 11511 if (OV->getSourceExpr()) 11512 SrcExpr = OV->getSourceExpr()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11513 11514 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr); 11515 if (!SL || !SL->isAscii()) 11516 return false; 11517 Diag(SL->getLocStart(), diag::err_missing_atsign_prefix) 11518 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@"); 11519 Exp = BuildObjCStringLiteral(SL->getLocStart(), SL).get(); 11520 return true; 11521 } 11522 11523 bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy, 11524 SourceLocation Loc, 11525 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType, 11526 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action, 11527 bool *Complained) { 11528 if (Complained) 11529 *Complained = false; 11530 11531 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions). 11532 bool CheckInferredResultType = false; 11533 bool isInvalid = false; 11534 unsigned DiagKind = 0; 11535 FixItHint Hint; 11536 ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints; 11537 bool MayHaveConvFixit = false; 11538 bool MayHaveFunctionDiff = false; 11539 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 11540 const ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = nullptr; 11541 11542 switch (ConvTy) { 11543 case Compatible: 11544 DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(DstType, SrcType, SrcExpr); 11545 return false; 11546 11547 case PointerToInt: 11548 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int; 11549 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 11550 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 11551 break; 11552 case IntToPointer: 11553 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer; 11554 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 11555 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 11556 break; 11557 case IncompatiblePointer: 11558 DiagKind = 11559 (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited ? 11560 diag::err_arc_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer : 11561 diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer); 11562 CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 11563 SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType(); 11564 if (Hint.isNull() && !CheckInferredResultType) { 11565 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 11566 } 11567 else if (CheckInferredResultType) { 11568 SrcType = SrcType.getUnqualifiedType(); 11569 DstType = DstType.getUnqualifiedType(); 11570 } 11571 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 11572 break; 11573 case IncompatiblePointerSign: 11574 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign; 11575 break; 11576 case FunctionVoidPointer: 11577 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func; 11578 break; 11579 case IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: { 11580 // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary. 11581 if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType); 11582 11583 Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 11584 Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 11585 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) { 11586 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space; 11587 break; 11588 11589 11590 } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) { 11591 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership; 11592 break; 11593 } 11594 11595 llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!"); 11596 // fallthrough 11597 } 11598 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 11599 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the 11600 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char* 11601 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME: 11602 // Ideally, this check would be performed in 11603 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a 11604 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an 11605 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part 11606 // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for 11607 // C++ semantics. 11608 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 11609 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType)) 11610 return false; 11611 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers; 11612 break; 11613 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers: 11614 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch; 11615 break; 11616 case IntToBlockPointer: 11617 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer; 11618 break; 11619 case IncompatibleBlockPointer: 11620 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer; 11621 break; 11622 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId: { 11623 if (SrcType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 11624 const ObjCObjectPointerType *srcOPT = 11625 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 11626 for (auto *srcProto : srcOPT->quals()) { 11627 PDecl = srcProto; 11628 break; 11629 } 11630 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 11631 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 11632 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 11633 } 11634 else if (DstType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 11635 const ObjCObjectPointerType *dstOPT = 11636 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 11637 for (auto *dstProto : dstOPT->quals()) { 11638 PDecl = dstProto; 11639 break; 11640 } 11641 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 11642 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 11643 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 11644 } 11645 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id; 11646 break; 11647 } 11648 case IncompatibleVectors: 11649 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors; 11650 break; 11651 case IncompatibleObjCWeakRef: 11652 DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign; 11653 break; 11654 case Incompatible: 11655 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible; 11656 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 11657 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 11658 isInvalid = true; 11659 MayHaveFunctionDiff = true; 11660 break; 11661 } 11662 11663 QualType FirstType, SecondType; 11664 switch (Action) { 11665 case AA_Assigning: 11666 case AA_Initializing: 11667 // The destination type comes first. 11668 FirstType = DstType; 11669 SecondType = SrcType; 11670 break; 11671 11672 case AA_Returning: 11673 case AA_Passing: 11674 case AA_Passing_CFAudited: 11675 case AA_Converting: 11676 case AA_Sending: 11677 case AA_Casting: 11678 // The source type comes first. 11679 FirstType = SrcType; 11680 SecondType = DstType; 11681 break; 11682 } 11683 11684 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind); 11685 if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited) 11686 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << AA_Passing << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 11687 else 11688 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << Action << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 11689 11690 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 11691 assert(ConvHints.isNull() || Hint.isNull()); 11692 if (!ConvHints.isNull()) { 11693 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = ConvHints.Hints.begin(), 11694 HE = ConvHints.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 11695 FDiag << *HI; 11696 } else { 11697 FDiag << Hint; 11698 } 11699 if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); } 11700 11701 if (MayHaveFunctionDiff) 11702 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(FDiag, SecondType, FirstType); 11703 11704 Diag(Loc, FDiag); 11705 if (DiagKind == diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id && 11706 PDecl && IFace && !IFace->hasDefinition()) 11707 Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::not_incomplete_class_and_qualified_id) 11708 << IFace->getName() << PDecl->getName(); 11709 11710 if (SecondType == Context.OverloadTy) 11711 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression, 11712 FirstType); 11713 11714 if (CheckInferredResultType) 11715 EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr); 11716 11717 if (Action == AA_Returning && ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer) 11718 EmitRelatedResultTypeNoteForReturn(DstType); 11719 11720 if (Complained) 11721 *Complained = true; 11722 return isInvalid; 11723 } 11724 11725 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 11726 llvm::APSInt *Result) { 11727 class SimpleICEDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 11728 public: 11729 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 11730 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus << SR; 11731 } 11732 } Diagnoser; 11733 11734 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser); 11735 } 11736 11737 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 11738 llvm::APSInt *Result, 11739 unsigned DiagID, 11740 bool AllowFold) { 11741 class IDDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 11742 unsigned DiagID; 11743 11744 public: 11745 IDDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID) 11746 : VerifyICEDiagnoser(DiagID == 0), DiagID(DiagID) { } 11747 11748 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 11749 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << SR; 11750 } 11751 } Diagnoser(DiagID); 11752 11753 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, AllowFold); 11754 } 11755 11756 void Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 11757 SourceRange SR) { 11758 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_expr_not_ice) << SR << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus; 11759 } 11760 11761 ExprResult 11762 Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result, 11763 VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser, 11764 bool AllowFold) { 11765 SourceLocation DiagLoc = E->getLocStart(); 11766 11767 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 11768 // C++11 [expr.const]p5: 11769 // If an expression of literal class type is used in a context where an 11770 // integral constant expression is required, then that class type shall 11771 // have a single non-explicit conversion function to an integral or 11772 // unscoped enumeration type 11773 ExprResult Converted; 11774 class CXX11ConvertDiagnoser : public ICEConvertDiagnoser { 11775 public: 11776 CXX11ConvertDiagnoser(bool Silent) 11777 : ICEConvertDiagnoser(/*AllowScopedEnumerations*/false, 11778 Silent, true) {} 11779 11780 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 11781 QualType T) override { 11782 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_not_integral) << T; 11783 } 11784 11785 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete( 11786 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 11787 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_incomplete_type) << T; 11788 } 11789 11790 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv( 11791 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 11792 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_explicit_conversion) << T << ConvTy; 11793 } 11794 11795 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv( 11796 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 11797 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 11798 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 11799 } 11800 11801 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous( 11802 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 11803 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_ambiguous_conversion) << T; 11804 } 11805 11806 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous( 11807 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 11808 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 11809 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 11810 } 11811 11812 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion( 11813 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 11814 llvm_unreachable("conversion functions are permitted"); 11815 } 11816 } ConvertDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress); 11817 11818 Converted = PerformContextualImplicitConversion(DiagLoc, E, 11819 ConvertDiagnoser); 11820 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 11821 return Converted; 11822 E = Converted.get(); 11823 if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 11824 return ExprError(); 11825 } else if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 11826 // An ICE must be of integral or unscoped enumeration type. 11827 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) 11828 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 11829 return ExprError(); 11830 } 11831 11832 // Circumvent ICE checking in C++11 to avoid evaluating the expression twice 11833 // in the non-ICE case. 11834 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) { 11835 if (Result) 11836 *Result = E->EvaluateKnownConstInt(Context); 11837 return E; 11838 } 11839 11840 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult; 11841 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 11842 EvalResult.Diag = &Notes; 11843 11844 // Try to evaluate the expression, and produce diagnostics explaining why it's 11845 // not a constant expression as a side-effect. 11846 bool Folded = E->EvaluateAsRValue(EvalResult, Context) && 11847 EvalResult.Val.isInt() && !EvalResult.HasSideEffects; 11848 11849 // In C++11, we can rely on diagnostics being produced for any expression 11850 // which is not a constant expression. If no diagnostics were produced, then 11851 // this is a constant expression. 11852 if (Folded && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Notes.empty()) { 11853 if (Result) 11854 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 11855 return E; 11856 } 11857 11858 // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point 11859 // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially 11860 // redundant note. 11861 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 11862 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 11863 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 11864 Notes.clear(); 11865 } 11866 11867 if (!Folded || !AllowFold) { 11868 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) { 11869 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 11870 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 11871 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 11872 } 11873 11874 return ExprError(); 11875 } 11876 11877 Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 11878 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 11879 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 11880 11881 if (Result) 11882 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 11883 return E; 11884 } 11885 11886 namespace { 11887 // Handle the case where we conclude a expression which we speculatively 11888 // considered to be unevaluated is actually evaluated. 11889 class TransformToPE : public TreeTransform<TransformToPE> { 11890 typedef TreeTransform<TransformToPE> BaseTransform; 11891 11892 public: 11893 TransformToPE(Sema &SemaRef) : BaseTransform(SemaRef) { } 11894 11895 // Make sure we redo semantic analysis 11896 bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; } 11897 11898 // Make sure we handle LabelStmts correctly. 11899 // FIXME: This does the right thing, but maybe we need a more general 11900 // fix to TreeTransform? 11901 StmtResult TransformLabelStmt(LabelStmt *S) { 11902 S->getDecl()->setStmt(nullptr); 11903 return BaseTransform::TransformLabelStmt(S); 11904 } 11905 11906 // We need to special-case DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls which 11907 // are not part of a member pointer formation; normal TreeTransforming 11908 // doesn't catch this case because of the way we represent them in the AST. 11909 // FIXME: This is a bit ugly; is it really the best way to handle this 11910 // case? 11911 // 11912 // Error on DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls. 11913 ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 11914 if (isa<FieldDecl>(E->getDecl()) && 11915 !SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext()) 11916 return SemaRef.Diag(E->getLocation(), 11917 diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use) 11918 << E->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange(); 11919 11920 return BaseTransform::TransformDeclRefExpr(E); 11921 } 11922 11923 // Exception: filter out member pointer formation 11924 ExprResult TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 11925 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && E->getType()->isMemberPointerType()) 11926 return E; 11927 11928 return BaseTransform::TransformUnaryOperator(E); 11929 } 11930 11931 ExprResult TransformLambdaExpr(LambdaExpr *E) { 11932 // Lambdas never need to be transformed. 11933 return E; 11934 } 11935 }; 11936 } 11937 11938 ExprResult Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E) { 11939 assert(isUnevaluatedContext() && 11940 "Should only transform unevaluated expressions"); 11941 ExprEvalContexts.back().Context = 11942 ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size()-2].Context; 11943 if (isUnevaluatedContext()) 11944 return E; 11945 return TransformToPE(*this).TransformExpr(E); 11946 } 11947 11948 void 11949 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, 11950 Decl *LambdaContextDecl, 11951 bool IsDecltype) { 11952 ExprEvalContexts.emplace_back(NewContext, ExprCleanupObjects.size(), 11953 ExprNeedsCleanups, LambdaContextDecl, 11954 IsDecltype); 11955 ExprNeedsCleanups = false; 11956 if (!MaybeODRUseExprs.empty()) 11957 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, ExprEvalContexts.back().SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 11958 } 11959 11960 void 11961 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, 11962 ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t, 11963 bool IsDecltype) { 11964 Decl *ClosureContextDecl = ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl; 11965 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(NewContext, ClosureContextDecl, IsDecltype); 11966 } 11967 11968 void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() { 11969 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back(); 11970 unsigned NumTypos = Rec.NumTypos; 11971 11972 if (!Rec.Lambdas.empty()) { 11973 if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) { 11974 unsigned D; 11975 if (Rec.isUnevaluated()) { 11976 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p2: 11977 // A lambda-expression shall not appear in an unevaluated operand 11978 // (Clause 5). 11979 D = diag::err_lambda_unevaluated_operand; 11980 } else { 11981 // C++1y [expr.const]p2: 11982 // A conditional-expression e is a core constant expression unless the 11983 // evaluation of e, following the rules of the abstract machine, would 11984 // evaluate [...] a lambda-expression. 11985 D = diag::err_lambda_in_constant_expression; 11986 } 11987 for (const auto *L : Rec.Lambdas) 11988 Diag(L->getLocStart(), D); 11989 } else { 11990 // Mark the capture expressions odr-used. This was deferred 11991 // during lambda expression creation. 11992 for (auto *Lambda : Rec.Lambdas) { 11993 for (auto *C : Lambda->capture_inits()) 11994 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(C); 11995 } 11996 } 11997 } 11998 11999 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any 12000 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of 12001 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they 12002 // will never be constructed. 12003 if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) { 12004 ExprCleanupObjects.erase(ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + Rec.NumCleanupObjects, 12005 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 12006 ExprNeedsCleanups = Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups; 12007 CleanupVarDeclMarking(); 12008 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 12009 // Otherwise, merge the contexts together. 12010 } else { 12011 ExprNeedsCleanups |= Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups; 12012 MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.begin(), 12013 Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.end()); 12014 } 12015 12016 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack. 12017 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back(); 12018 12019 if (!ExprEvalContexts.empty()) 12020 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumTypos += NumTypos; 12021 else 12022 assert(NumTypos == 0 && "There are outstanding typos after popping the " 12023 "last ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord"); 12024 } 12025 12026 void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() { 12027 ExprCleanupObjects.erase( 12028 ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects, 12029 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 12030 ExprNeedsCleanups = false; 12031 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear(); 12032 } 12033 12034 ExprResult Sema::HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E) { 12035 if (!E->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 12036 return E; 12037 return TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 12038 } 12039 12040 static bool IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(Sema &SemaRef) { 12041 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for 12042 // an instantiation. 12043 if (SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext()) 12044 return false; 12045 12046 switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 12047 case Sema::Unevaluated: 12048 case Sema::UnevaluatedAbstract: 12049 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing. 12050 // (Depending on how you read the standard, we actually do need to do 12051 // something here for null pointer constants, but the standard's 12052 // definition of a null pointer constant is completely crazy.) 12053 return false; 12054 12055 case Sema::ConstantEvaluated: 12056 case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluated: 12057 // We are in a potentially evaluated expression (or a constant-expression 12058 // in C++03); we need to do implicit template instantiation, implicitly 12059 // define class members, and mark most declarations as used. 12060 return true; 12061 12062 case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 12063 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the 12064 // containing expression is used. 12065 return false; 12066 } 12067 llvm_unreachable("Invalid context"); 12068 } 12069 12070 /// \brief Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 12071 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3) 12072 void Sema::MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func, 12073 bool OdrUse) { 12074 assert(Func && "No function?"); 12075 12076 Func->setReferenced(); 12077 12078 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p3: 12079 // A function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression is 12080 // odr-used if it is the unique lookup result or the selected member of a 12081 // set of overloaded functions [...]. 12082 // 12083 // We (incorrectly) mark overload resolution as an unevaluated context, so we 12084 // can just check that here. Skip the rest of this function if we've already 12085 // marked the function as used. 12086 if (Func->isUsed(/*CheckUsedAttr=*/false) || 12087 !IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(*this)) { 12088 // C++11 [temp.inst]p3: 12089 // Unless a function template specialization has been explicitly 12090 // instantiated or explicitly specialized, the function template 12091 // specialization is implicitly instantiated when the specialization is 12092 // referenced in a context that requires a function definition to exist. 12093 // 12094 // We consider constexpr function templates to be referenced in a context 12095 // that requires a definition to exist whenever they are referenced. 12096 // 12097 // FIXME: This instantiates constexpr functions too frequently. If this is 12098 // really an unevaluated context (and we're not just in the definition of a 12099 // function template or overload resolution or other cases which we 12100 // incorrectly consider to be unevaluated contexts), and we're not in a 12101 // subexpression which we actually need to evaluate (for instance, a 12102 // template argument, array bound or an expression in a braced-init-list), 12103 // we are not permitted to instantiate this constexpr function definition. 12104 // 12105 // FIXME: This also implicitly defines special members too frequently. They 12106 // are only supposed to be implicitly defined if they are odr-used, but they 12107 // are not odr-used from constant expressions in unevaluated contexts. 12108 // However, they cannot be referenced if they are deleted, and they are 12109 // deleted whenever the implicit definition of the special member would 12110 // fail. 12111 if (!Func->isConstexpr() || Func->getBody()) 12112 return; 12113 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func); 12114 if (!Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable() && (!MD || MD->isUserProvided())) 12115 return; 12116 } 12117 12118 // Note that this declaration has been used. 12119 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 12120 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Constructor->getFirstDecl()); 12121 if (Constructor->isDefaulted() && !Constructor->isDeleted()) { 12122 if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) { 12123 if (Constructor->isTrivial() && !Constructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 12124 return; 12125 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 12126 } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) { 12127 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 12128 } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) { 12129 DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 12130 } 12131 } else if (Constructor->getInheritedConstructor()) { 12132 DefineInheritingConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 12133 } 12134 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 12135 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) { 12136 Destructor = cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Destructor->getFirstDecl()); 12137 if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isDeleted()) { 12138 if (Destructor->isTrivial() && !Destructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 12139 return; 12140 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor); 12141 } 12142 if (Destructor->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext) 12143 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent()); 12144 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func)) { 12145 if (MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() && 12146 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) { 12147 MethodDecl = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 12148 if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && !MethodDecl->isDeleted()) { 12149 if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 12150 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 12151 else 12152 DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 12153 } 12154 } else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl) && 12155 MethodDecl->getParent()->isLambda()) { 12156 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 12157 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 12158 if (Conversion->isLambdaToBlockPointerConversion()) 12159 DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 12160 else 12161 DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 12162 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext) 12163 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent()); 12164 } 12165 12166 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function. 12167 // FIXME: Is this really right? 12168 if (CurContext == Func) return; 12169 12170 // Resolve the exception specification for any function which is 12171 // used: CodeGen will need it. 12172 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 12173 if (FPT && isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) 12174 ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 12175 12176 if (!OdrUse) return; 12177 12178 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of 12179 // class templates. 12180 if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) { 12181 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false; 12182 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 12183 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo 12184 = Func->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) { 12185 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) 12186 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc); 12187 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind() 12188 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) { 12189 AlreadyInstantiated = true; 12190 PointOfInstantiation = SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation(); 12191 } 12192 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo 12193 = Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) { 12194 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) 12195 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc); 12196 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind() 12197 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) { 12198 AlreadyInstantiated = true; 12199 PointOfInstantiation = MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation(); 12200 } 12201 } 12202 12203 if (!AlreadyInstantiated || Func->isConstexpr()) { 12204 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()) && 12205 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass() && 12206 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.size()) 12207 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back( 12208 std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation)); 12209 else if (Func->isConstexpr()) 12210 // Do not defer instantiations of constexpr functions, to avoid the 12211 // expression evaluator needing to call back into Sema if it sees a 12212 // call to such a function. 12213 InstantiateFunctionDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Func); 12214 else { 12215 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Func, 12216 PointOfInstantiation)); 12217 // Notify the consumer that a function was implicitly instantiated. 12218 Consumer.HandleCXXImplicitFunctionInstantiation(Func); 12219 } 12220 } 12221 } else { 12222 // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable. 12223 for (auto i : Func->redecls()) { 12224 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) 12225 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, i); 12226 } 12227 } 12228 12229 // Keep track of used but undefined functions. 12230 if (!Func->isDefined()) { 12231 if (mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(Func)) 12232 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 12233 else if (Func->getMostRecentDecl()->isInlined() && 12234 (LangOpts.CPlusPlus || !LangOpts.GNUInline) && 12235 !Func->getMostRecentDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 12236 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 12237 } 12238 12239 // Normally the most current decl is marked used while processing the use and 12240 // any subsequent decls are marked used by decl merging. This fails with 12241 // template instantiation since marking can happen at the end of the file 12242 // and, because of the two phase lookup, this function is called with at 12243 // decl in the middle of a decl chain. We loop to maintain the invariant 12244 // that once a decl is used, all decls after it are also used. 12245 for (FunctionDecl *F = Func->getMostRecentDecl();; F = F->getPreviousDecl()) { 12246 F->markUsed(Context); 12247 if (F == Func) 12248 break; 12249 } 12250 } 12251 12252 static void 12253 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc, 12254 VarDecl *var, DeclContext *DC) { 12255 DeclContext *VarDC = var->getDeclContext(); 12256 12257 // If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then 12258 // we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of 12259 // the next. 12260 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var) && 12261 isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(VarDC)) 12262 return; 12263 12264 // For C code, don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code 12265 // right now; it's impossible to write a non-constant expression outside of 12266 // function context, so we'll get other (more useful) diagnostics later. 12267 // 12268 // For C++, things get a bit more nasty... it would be nice to suppress this 12269 // diagnostic for certain cases like using a local variable in an array bound 12270 // for a member of a local class, but the correct predicate is not obvious. 12271 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 12272 return; 12273 12274 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VarDC) && 12275 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VarDC->getParent())->isLambda()) { 12276 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_lambda) 12277 << var->getIdentifier(); 12278 } else if (FunctionDecl *fn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VarDC)) { 12279 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function) 12280 << var->getIdentifier() << fn->getDeclName(); 12281 } else if (isa<BlockDecl>(VarDC)) { 12282 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_block) 12283 << var->getIdentifier(); 12284 } else { 12285 // FIXME: Is there any other context where a local variable can be 12286 // declared? 12287 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_context) 12288 << var->getIdentifier(); 12289 } 12290 12291 S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 12292 << var->getIdentifier(); 12293 12294 // FIXME: Add additional diagnostic info about class etc. which prevents 12295 // capture. 12296 } 12297 12298 12299 static bool isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 12300 bool &SubCapturesAreNested, 12301 QualType &CaptureType, 12302 QualType &DeclRefType) { 12303 // Check whether we've already captured it. 12304 if (CSI->CaptureMap.count(Var)) { 12305 // If we found a capture, any subcaptures are nested. 12306 SubCapturesAreNested = true; 12307 12308 // Retrieve the capture type for this variable. 12309 CaptureType = CSI->getCapture(Var).getCaptureType(); 12310 12311 // Compute the type of an expression that refers to this variable. 12312 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 12313 12314 const CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = CSI->getCapture(Var); 12315 if (Cap.isCopyCapture() && 12316 !(isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI) && cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Mutable)) 12317 DeclRefType.addConst(); 12318 return true; 12319 } 12320 return false; 12321 } 12322 12323 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 12324 // capture; other scopes don't work. 12325 static DeclContext *getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext *DC, VarDecl *Var, 12326 SourceLocation Loc, 12327 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 12328 if (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) || isa<CapturedDecl>(DC) || isLambdaCallOperator(DC)) 12329 return getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 12330 else if (Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 12331 if (Diagnose) 12332 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(S, Loc, Var, DC); 12333 } 12334 return nullptr; 12335 } 12336 12337 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 12338 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 12339 // so check for eligibility. 12340 static bool isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 12341 SourceLocation Loc, 12342 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 12343 12344 bool IsBlock = isa<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI); 12345 bool IsLambda = isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 12346 12347 // Lambdas are not allowed to capture unnamed variables 12348 // (e.g. anonymous unions). 12349 // FIXME: The C++11 rule don't actually state this explicitly, but I'm 12350 // assuming that's the intent. 12351 if (IsLambda && !Var->getDeclName()) { 12352 if (Diagnose) { 12353 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_anonymous_var); 12354 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 12355 } 12356 return false; 12357 } 12358 12359 // Prohibit variably-modified types in blocks; they're difficult to deal with. 12360 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && IsBlock) { 12361 if (Diagnose) { 12362 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type); 12363 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12364 << Var->getDeclName(); 12365 } 12366 return false; 12367 } 12368 // Prohibit structs with flexible array members too. 12369 // We cannot capture what is in the tail end of the struct. 12370 if (const RecordType *VTTy = Var->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 12371 if (VTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 12372 if (Diagnose) { 12373 if (IsBlock) 12374 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_flexarray_type); 12375 else 12376 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_flexarray_type) 12377 << Var->getDeclName(); 12378 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12379 << Var->getDeclName(); 12380 } 12381 return false; 12382 } 12383 } 12384 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 12385 // Lambdas and captured statements are not allowed to capture __block 12386 // variables; they don't support the expected semantics. 12387 if (HasBlocksAttr && (IsLambda || isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))) { 12388 if (Diagnose) { 12389 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_capture_block_variable) 12390 << Var->getDeclName() << !IsLambda; 12391 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12392 << Var->getDeclName(); 12393 } 12394 return false; 12395 } 12396 12397 return true; 12398 } 12399 12400 // Returns true if the capture by block was successful. 12401 static bool captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo *BSI, VarDecl *Var, 12402 SourceLocation Loc, 12403 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 12404 QualType &CaptureType, 12405 QualType &DeclRefType, 12406 const bool Nested, 12407 Sema &S) { 12408 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 12409 bool ByRef = false; 12410 12411 // Blocks are not allowed to capture arrays. 12412 if (CaptureType->isArrayType()) { 12413 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12414 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type); 12415 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12416 << Var->getDeclName(); 12417 } 12418 return false; 12419 } 12420 12421 // Forbid the block-capture of autoreleasing variables. 12422 if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 12423 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12424 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) 12425 << /*block*/ 0; 12426 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12427 << Var->getDeclName(); 12428 } 12429 return false; 12430 } 12431 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 12432 if (HasBlocksAttr || CaptureType->isReferenceType()) { 12433 // Block capture by reference does not change the capture or 12434 // declaration reference types. 12435 ByRef = true; 12436 } else { 12437 // Block capture by copy introduces 'const'. 12438 CaptureType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().withConst(); 12439 DeclRefType = CaptureType; 12440 12441 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuildAndDiagnose) { 12442 if (const RecordType *Record = DeclRefType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 12443 // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it. 12444 // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have 12445 // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are 12446 // an exception because it's technically only the call site that 12447 // actually requires the destructor. 12448 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 12449 S.FinalizeVarWithDestructor(Var, Record); 12450 12451 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the copy 12452 // full-expression. 12453 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext scope(S, S.PotentiallyEvaluated); 12454 12455 // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from 12456 // the stack requires a const copy constructor. This is not true 12457 // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap. 12458 Expr *DeclRef = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, Nested, 12459 DeclRefType.withConst(), 12460 VK_LValue, Loc); 12461 12462 ExprResult Result 12463 = S.PerformCopyInitialization( 12464 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(Var->getLocation(), 12465 CaptureType, false), 12466 Loc, DeclRef); 12467 12468 // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization 12469 // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor. Recover from 12470 // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary. 12471 if (!Result.isInvalid() && 12472 !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Result.get())->getConstructor() 12473 ->isTrivial()) { 12474 Result = S.MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Result); 12475 CopyExpr = Result.get(); 12476 } 12477 } 12478 } 12479 } 12480 12481 // Actually capture the variable. 12482 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 12483 BSI->addCapture(Var, HasBlocksAttr, ByRef, Nested, Loc, 12484 SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr); 12485 12486 return true; 12487 12488 } 12489 12490 12491 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the captured region. 12492 static bool captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI, 12493 VarDecl *Var, 12494 SourceLocation Loc, 12495 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 12496 QualType &CaptureType, 12497 QualType &DeclRefType, 12498 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable, 12499 Sema &S) { 12500 12501 // By default, capture variables by reference. 12502 bool ByRef = true; 12503 // Using an LValue reference type is consistent with Lambdas (see below). 12504 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 12505 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 12506 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12507 // The current implementation assumes that all variables are captured 12508 // by references. Since there is no capture by copy, no expression 12509 // evaluation will be needed. 12510 RecordDecl *RD = RSI->TheRecordDecl; 12511 12512 FieldDecl *Field 12513 = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, RD, Loc, Loc, nullptr, CaptureType, 12514 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CaptureType, Loc), 12515 nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit); 12516 Field->setImplicit(true); 12517 Field->setAccess(AS_private); 12518 RD->addDecl(Field); 12519 12520 CopyExpr = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, RefersToCapturedVariable, 12521 DeclRefType, VK_LValue, Loc); 12522 Var->setReferenced(true); 12523 Var->markUsed(S.Context); 12524 } 12525 12526 // Actually capture the variable. 12527 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 12528 RSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, Loc, 12529 SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr); 12530 12531 12532 return true; 12533 } 12534 12535 /// \brief Create a field within the lambda class for the variable 12536 /// being captured. 12537 static void addAsFieldToClosureType(Sema &S, LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, VarDecl *Var, 12538 QualType FieldType, QualType DeclRefType, 12539 SourceLocation Loc, 12540 bool RefersToCapturedVariable) { 12541 CXXRecordDecl *Lambda = LSI->Lambda; 12542 12543 // Build the non-static data member. 12544 FieldDecl *Field 12545 = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, Lambda, Loc, Loc, nullptr, FieldType, 12546 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FieldType, Loc), 12547 nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit); 12548 Field->setImplicit(true); 12549 Field->setAccess(AS_private); 12550 Lambda->addDecl(Field); 12551 } 12552 12553 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the lambda. 12554 static bool captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 12555 VarDecl *Var, 12556 SourceLocation Loc, 12557 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 12558 QualType &CaptureType, 12559 QualType &DeclRefType, 12560 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable, 12561 const Sema::TryCaptureKind Kind, 12562 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, 12563 const bool IsTopScope, 12564 Sema &S) { 12565 12566 // Determine whether we are capturing by reference or by value. 12567 bool ByRef = false; 12568 if (IsTopScope && Kind != Sema::TryCapture_Implicit) { 12569 ByRef = (Kind == Sema::TryCapture_ExplicitByRef); 12570 } else { 12571 ByRef = (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref); 12572 } 12573 12574 // Compute the type of the field that will capture this variable. 12575 if (ByRef) { 12576 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p15: 12577 // An entity is captured by reference if it is implicitly or 12578 // explicitly captured but not captured by copy. It is 12579 // unspecified whether additional unnamed non-static data 12580 // members are declared in the closure type for entities 12581 // captured by reference. 12582 // 12583 // FIXME: It is not clear whether we want to build an lvalue reference 12584 // to the DeclRefType or to CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(). GCC appears 12585 // to do the former, while EDG does the latter. Core issue 1249 will 12586 // clarify, but for now we follow GCC because it's a more permissive and 12587 // easily defensible position. 12588 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 12589 } else { 12590 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p14: 12591 // For each entity captured by copy, an unnamed non-static 12592 // data member is declared in the closure type. The 12593 // declaration order of these members is unspecified. The type 12594 // of such a data member is the type of the corresponding 12595 // captured entity if the entity is not a reference to an 12596 // object, or the referenced type otherwise. [Note: If the 12597 // captured entity is a reference to a function, the 12598 // corresponding data member is also a reference to a 12599 // function. - end note ] 12600 if (const ReferenceType *RefType = CaptureType->getAs<ReferenceType>()){ 12601 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 12602 CaptureType = RefType->getPointeeType(); 12603 } 12604 12605 // Forbid the lambda copy-capture of autoreleasing variables. 12606 if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 12607 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12608 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) << /*lambda*/ 1; 12609 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12610 << Var->getDeclName(); 12611 } 12612 return false; 12613 } 12614 12615 // Make sure that by-copy captures are of a complete and non-abstract type. 12616 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12617 if (!CaptureType->isDependentType() && 12618 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, CaptureType, 12619 diag::err_capture_of_incomplete_type, 12620 Var->getDeclName())) 12621 return false; 12622 12623 if (S.RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, CaptureType, 12624 diag::err_capture_of_abstract_type)) 12625 return false; 12626 } 12627 } 12628 12629 // Capture this variable in the lambda. 12630 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 12631 addAsFieldToClosureType(S, LSI, Var, CaptureType, DeclRefType, Loc, 12632 RefersToCapturedVariable); 12633 12634 // Compute the type of a reference to this captured variable. 12635 if (ByRef) 12636 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 12637 else { 12638 // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p5: 12639 // The closure type for a lambda-expression has a public inline 12640 // function call operator [...]. This function call operator is 12641 // declared const (9.3.1) if and only if the lambda-expression’s 12642 // parameter-declaration-clause is not followed by mutable. 12643 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 12644 if (!LSI->Mutable && !CaptureType->isReferenceType()) 12645 DeclRefType.addConst(); 12646 } 12647 12648 // Add the capture. 12649 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 12650 LSI->addCapture(Var, /*IsBlock=*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, 12651 Loc, EllipsisLoc, CaptureType, /*CopyExpr=*/nullptr); 12652 12653 return true; 12654 } 12655 12656 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable( 12657 VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation ExprLoc, TryCaptureKind Kind, 12658 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, bool BuildAndDiagnose, QualType &CaptureType, 12659 QualType &DeclRefType, const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 12660 // An init-capture is notionally from the context surrounding its 12661 // declaration, but its parent DC is the lambda class. 12662 DeclContext *VarDC = Var->getDeclContext(); 12663 if (Var->isInitCapture()) 12664 VarDC = VarDC->getParent(); 12665 12666 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 12667 const unsigned MaxFunctionScopesIndex = FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 12668 ? *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt : FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 12669 // We need to sync up the Declaration Context with the 12670 // FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 12671 if (FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 12672 unsigned FSIndex = FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 12673 while (FSIndex != MaxFunctionScopesIndex) { 12674 DC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 12675 --FSIndex; 12676 } 12677 } 12678 12679 12680 // If the variable is declared in the current context, there is no need to 12681 // capture it. 12682 if (VarDC == DC) return true; 12683 12684 // Capture global variables if it is required to use private copy of this 12685 // variable. 12686 bool IsGlobal = !Var->hasLocalStorage(); 12687 if (IsGlobal && !(LangOpts.OpenMP && IsOpenMPCapturedVar(Var))) 12688 return true; 12689 12690 // Walk up the stack to determine whether we can capture the variable, 12691 // performing the "simple" checks that don't depend on type. We stop when 12692 // we've either hit the declared scope of the variable or find an existing 12693 // capture of that variable. We start from the innermost capturing-entity 12694 // (the DC) and ensure that all intervening capturing-entities 12695 // (blocks/lambdas etc.) between the innermost capturer and the variable`s 12696 // declcontext can either capture the variable or have already captured 12697 // the variable. 12698 CaptureType = Var->getType(); 12699 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 12700 bool Nested = false; 12701 bool Explicit = (Kind != TryCapture_Implicit); 12702 unsigned FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex; 12703 do { 12704 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 12705 // capture; other scopes don't work. 12706 DeclContext *ParentDC = getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DC, Var, 12707 ExprLoc, 12708 BuildAndDiagnose, 12709 *this); 12710 // We need to check for the parent *first* because, if we *have* 12711 // private-captured a global variable, we need to recursively capture it in 12712 // intermediate blocks, lambdas, etc. 12713 if (!ParentDC) { 12714 if (IsGlobal) { 12715 FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex - 1; 12716 break; 12717 } 12718 return true; 12719 } 12720 12721 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex]; 12722 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FSI); 12723 12724 12725 // Check whether we've already captured it. 12726 if (isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CSI, Var, Nested, CaptureType, 12727 DeclRefType)) 12728 break; 12729 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator body, 12730 // we do not want to capture new variables. What was captured 12731 // during either a lambdas transformation or initial parsing 12732 // should be used. 12733 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(DC)) { 12734 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12735 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 12736 if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None) { 12737 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 12738 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12739 << Var->getDeclName(); 12740 Diag(LSI->Lambda->getLocStart(), diag::note_lambda_decl); 12741 } else 12742 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, ExprLoc, Var, DC); 12743 } 12744 return true; 12745 } 12746 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 12747 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 12748 // so check for eligibility. 12749 if (!isVariableCapturable(CSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, *this)) 12750 return true; 12751 12752 // Try to capture variable-length arrays types. 12753 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 12754 // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA 12755 // expressions. 12756 QualType QTy = Var->getType(); 12757 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 12758 QTy = PVD->getOriginalType(); 12759 do { 12760 const Type *Ty = QTy.getTypePtr(); 12761 switch (Ty->getTypeClass()) { 12762 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 12763 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 12764 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) 12765 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 12766 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) 12767 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 12768 QTy = QualType(); 12769 break; 12770 // These types are never variably-modified. 12771 case Type::Builtin: 12772 case Type::Complex: 12773 case Type::Vector: 12774 case Type::ExtVector: 12775 case Type::Record: 12776 case Type::Enum: 12777 case Type::Elaborated: 12778 case Type::TemplateSpecialization: 12779 case Type::ObjCObject: 12780 case Type::ObjCInterface: 12781 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: 12782 llvm_unreachable("type class is never variably-modified!"); 12783 case Type::Adjusted: 12784 QTy = cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)->getOriginalType(); 12785 break; 12786 case Type::Decayed: 12787 QTy = cast<DecayedType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12788 break; 12789 case Type::Pointer: 12790 QTy = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12791 break; 12792 case Type::BlockPointer: 12793 QTy = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12794 break; 12795 case Type::LValueReference: 12796 case Type::RValueReference: 12797 QTy = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12798 break; 12799 case Type::MemberPointer: 12800 QTy = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12801 break; 12802 case Type::ConstantArray: 12803 case Type::IncompleteArray: 12804 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 12805 QTy = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType(); 12806 break; 12807 case Type::VariableArray: { 12808 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 12809 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(Ty); 12810 12811 // Unknown size indication requires no size computation. 12812 // Otherwise, evaluate and record it. 12813 if (auto Size = VAT->getSizeExpr()) { 12814 if (!CSI->isVLATypeCaptured(VAT)) { 12815 RecordDecl *CapRecord = nullptr; 12816 if (auto LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 12817 CapRecord = LSI->Lambda; 12818 } else if (auto CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 12819 CapRecord = CRSI->TheRecordDecl; 12820 } 12821 if (CapRecord) { 12822 auto ExprLoc = Size->getExprLoc(); 12823 auto SizeType = Context.getSizeType(); 12824 // Build the non-static data member. 12825 auto Field = FieldDecl::Create( 12826 Context, CapRecord, ExprLoc, ExprLoc, 12827 /*Id*/ nullptr, SizeType, /*TInfo*/ nullptr, 12828 /*BW*/ nullptr, /*Mutable*/ false, 12829 /*InitStyle*/ ICIS_NoInit); 12830 Field->setImplicit(true); 12831 Field->setAccess(AS_private); 12832 Field->setCapturedVLAType(VAT); 12833 CapRecord->addDecl(Field); 12834 12835 CSI->addVLATypeCapture(ExprLoc, SizeType); 12836 } 12837 } 12838 } 12839 QTy = VAT->getElementType(); 12840 break; 12841 } 12842 case Type::FunctionProto: 12843 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 12844 QTy = cast<FunctionType>(Ty)->getReturnType(); 12845 break; 12846 case Type::Paren: 12847 case Type::TypeOf: 12848 case Type::UnaryTransform: 12849 case Type::Attributed: 12850 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm: 12851 case Type::PackExpansion: 12852 // Keep walking after single level desugaring. 12853 QTy = QTy.getSingleStepDesugaredType(getASTContext()); 12854 break; 12855 case Type::Typedef: 12856 QTy = cast<TypedefType>(Ty)->desugar(); 12857 break; 12858 case Type::Decltype: 12859 QTy = cast<DecltypeType>(Ty)->desugar(); 12860 break; 12861 case Type::Auto: 12862 QTy = cast<AutoType>(Ty)->getDeducedType(); 12863 break; 12864 case Type::TypeOfExpr: 12865 QTy = cast<TypeOfExprType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType(); 12866 break; 12867 case Type::Atomic: 12868 QTy = cast<AtomicType>(Ty)->getValueType(); 12869 break; 12870 } 12871 } while (!QTy.isNull() && QTy->isVariablyModifiedType()); 12872 } 12873 12874 if (CSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None && !Explicit) { 12875 // No capture-default, and this is not an explicit capture 12876 // so cannot capture this variable. 12877 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12878 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 12879 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12880 << Var->getDeclName(); 12881 Diag(cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda->getLocStart(), 12882 diag::note_lambda_decl); 12883 // FIXME: If we error out because an outer lambda can not implicitly 12884 // capture a variable that an inner lambda explicitly captures, we 12885 // should have the inner lambda do the explicit capture - because 12886 // it makes for cleaner diagnostics later. This would purely be done 12887 // so that the diagnostic does not misleadingly claim that a variable 12888 // can not be captured by a lambda implicitly even though it is captured 12889 // explicitly. Suggestion: 12890 // - create const bool VariableCaptureWasInitiallyExplicit = Explicit 12891 // at the function head 12892 // - cache the StartingDeclContext - this must be a lambda 12893 // - captureInLambda in the innermost lambda the variable. 12894 } 12895 return true; 12896 } 12897 12898 FunctionScopesIndex--; 12899 DC = ParentDC; 12900 Explicit = false; 12901 } while (!VarDC->Equals(DC)); 12902 12903 // Walk back down the scope stack, (e.g. from outer lambda to inner lambda) 12904 // computing the type of the capture at each step, checking type-specific 12905 // requirements, and adding captures if requested. 12906 // If the variable had already been captured previously, we start capturing 12907 // at the lambda nested within that one. 12908 for (unsigned I = ++FunctionScopesIndex, N = MaxFunctionScopesIndex + 1; I != N; 12909 ++I) { 12910 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[I]); 12911 12912 if (BlockScopeInfo *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 12913 if (!captureInBlock(BSI, Var, ExprLoc, 12914 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 12915 DeclRefType, Nested, *this)) 12916 return true; 12917 Nested = true; 12918 } else if (CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 12919 if (!captureInCapturedRegion(RSI, Var, ExprLoc, 12920 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 12921 DeclRefType, Nested, *this)) 12922 return true; 12923 Nested = true; 12924 } else { 12925 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 12926 if (!captureInLambda(LSI, Var, ExprLoc, 12927 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 12928 DeclRefType, Nested, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 12929 /*IsTopScope*/I == N - 1, *this)) 12930 return true; 12931 Nested = true; 12932 } 12933 } 12934 return false; 12935 } 12936 12937 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc, 12938 TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc) { 12939 QualType CaptureType; 12940 QualType DeclRefType; 12941 return tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 12942 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/true, CaptureType, 12943 DeclRefType, nullptr); 12944 } 12945 12946 bool Sema::NeedToCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) { 12947 QualType CaptureType; 12948 QualType DeclRefType; 12949 return !tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(), 12950 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, 12951 DeclRefType, nullptr); 12952 } 12953 12954 QualType Sema::getCapturedDeclRefType(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) { 12955 QualType CaptureType; 12956 QualType DeclRefType; 12957 12958 // Determine whether we can capture this variable. 12959 if (tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(), 12960 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, 12961 DeclRefType, nullptr)) 12962 return QualType(); 12963 12964 return DeclRefType; 12965 } 12966 12967 12968 12969 // If either the type of the variable or the initializer is dependent, 12970 // return false. Otherwise, determine whether the variable is a constant 12971 // expression. Use this if you need to know if a variable that might or 12972 // might not be dependent is truly a constant expression. 12973 static inline bool IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(VarDecl *Var, 12974 ASTContext &Context) { 12975 12976 if (Var->getType()->isDependentType()) 12977 return false; 12978 const VarDecl *DefVD = nullptr; 12979 Var->getAnyInitializer(DefVD); 12980 if (!DefVD) 12981 return false; 12982 EvaluatedStmt *Eval = DefVD->ensureEvaluatedStmt(); 12983 Expr *Init = cast<Expr>(Eval->Value); 12984 if (Init->isValueDependent()) 12985 return false; 12986 return IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, Context); 12987 } 12988 12989 12990 void Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Expr *E) { 12991 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it is 12992 // an object that satisfies the requirements for appearing in a 12993 // constant expression (5.19) and the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1) 12994 // is immediately applied." This function handles the lvalue-to-rvalue 12995 // conversion part. 12996 MaybeODRUseExprs.erase(E->IgnoreParens()); 12997 12998 // If we are in a lambda, check if this DeclRefExpr or MemberExpr refers 12999 // to a variable that is a constant expression, and if so, identify it as 13000 // a reference to a variable that does not involve an odr-use of that 13001 // variable. 13002 if (LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) { 13003 Expr *SansParensExpr = E->IgnoreParens(); 13004 VarDecl *Var = nullptr; 13005 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SansParensExpr)) 13006 Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getFoundDecl()); 13007 else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(SansParensExpr)) 13008 Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 13009 13010 if (Var && IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, Context)) 13011 LSI->markVariableExprAsNonODRUsed(SansParensExpr); 13012 } 13013 } 13014 13015 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res) { 13016 Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Res); 13017 13018 if (!Res.isUsable()) 13019 return Res; 13020 13021 // If a constant-expression is a reference to a variable where we delay 13022 // deciding whether it is an odr-use, just assume we will apply the 13023 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion. In the one case where this doesn't happen 13024 // (a non-type template argument), we have special handling anyway. 13025 UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Res.get()); 13026 return Res; 13027 } 13028 13029 void Sema::CleanupVarDeclMarking() { 13030 for (llvm::SmallPtrSetIterator<Expr*> i = MaybeODRUseExprs.begin(), 13031 e = MaybeODRUseExprs.end(); 13032 i != e; ++i) { 13033 VarDecl *Var; 13034 SourceLocation Loc; 13035 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(*i)) { 13036 Var = cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 13037 Loc = DRE->getLocation(); 13038 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(*i)) { 13039 Var = cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 13040 Loc = ME->getMemberLoc(); 13041 } else { 13042 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected expression"); 13043 } 13044 13045 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, *this, 13046 /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex Pointer*/ nullptr); 13047 } 13048 13049 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear(); 13050 } 13051 13052 13053 static void DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 13054 VarDecl *Var, Expr *E) { 13055 assert((!E || isa<DeclRefExpr>(E) || isa<MemberExpr>(E)) && 13056 "Invalid Expr argument to DoMarkVarDeclReferenced"); 13057 Var->setReferenced(); 13058 13059 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind(); 13060 bool MarkODRUsed = true; 13061 13062 // If the context is not potentially evaluated, this is not an odr-use and 13063 // does not trigger instantiation. 13064 if (!IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(SemaRef)) { 13065 if (SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext()) 13066 return; 13067 13068 // If we don't yet know whether this context is going to end up being an 13069 // evaluated context, and we're referencing a variable from an enclosing 13070 // scope, add a potential capture. 13071 // 13072 // FIXME: Is this necessary? These contexts are only used for default 13073 // arguments, where local variables can't be used. 13074 const bool RefersToEnclosingScope = 13075 (SemaRef.CurContext != Var->getDeclContext() && 13076 Var->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && Var->hasLocalStorage()); 13077 if (RefersToEnclosingScope) { 13078 if (LambdaScopeInfo *const LSI = SemaRef.getCurLambda()) { 13079 // If a variable could potentially be odr-used, defer marking it so 13080 // until we finish analyzing the full expression for any 13081 // lvalue-to-rvalue 13082 // or discarded value conversions that would obviate odr-use. 13083 // Add it to the list of potential captures that will be analyzed 13084 // later (ActOnFinishFullExpr) for eventual capture and odr-use marking 13085 // unless the variable is a reference that was initialized by a constant 13086 // expression (this will never need to be captured or odr-used). 13087 assert(E && "Capture variable should be used in an expression."); 13088 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() || 13089 !IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context)) 13090 LSI->addPotentialCapture(E->IgnoreParens()); 13091 } 13092 } 13093 13094 if (!isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) 13095 return; 13096 13097 // Instantiate, but do not mark as odr-used, variable templates. 13098 MarkODRUsed = false; 13099 } 13100 13101 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec = 13102 dyn_cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var); 13103 assert(!isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Var) && 13104 "Can't instantiate a partial template specialization."); 13105 13106 // Perform implicit instantiation of static data members, static data member 13107 // templates of class templates, and variable template specializations. Delay 13108 // instantiations of variable templates, except for those that could be used 13109 // in a constant expression. 13110 if (isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) { 13111 bool TryInstantiating = TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation; 13112 13113 if (TryInstantiating && !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) { 13114 if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) { 13115 // This is a modification of an existing AST node. Notify listeners. 13116 if (ASTMutationListener *L = SemaRef.getASTMutationListener()) 13117 L->StaticDataMemberInstantiated(Var); 13118 } else if (!Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) 13119 // Don't bother trying to instantiate it again, unless we might need 13120 // its initializer before we get to the end of the TU. 13121 TryInstantiating = false; 13122 } 13123 13124 if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) 13125 Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, Loc); 13126 13127 if (TryInstantiating) { 13128 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Var->getPointOfInstantiation(); 13129 bool InstantiationDependent = false; 13130 bool IsNonDependent = 13131 VarSpec ? !TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments( 13132 VarSpec->getTemplateArgsInfo(), InstantiationDependent) 13133 : true; 13134 13135 // Do not instantiate specializations that are still type-dependent. 13136 if (IsNonDependent) { 13137 if (Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) { 13138 // Do not defer instantiations of variables which could be used in a 13139 // constant expression. 13140 SemaRef.InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var); 13141 } else { 13142 SemaRef.PendingInstantiations 13143 .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation)); 13144 } 13145 } 13146 } 13147 } 13148 13149 if(!MarkODRUsed) return; 13150 13151 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it satisfies 13152 // the requirements for appearing in a constant expression (5.19) and, if 13153 // it is an object, the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1) 13154 // is immediately applied." We check the first part here, and 13155 // Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue deals with the second part. 13156 // Note that we use the C++11 definition everywhere because nothing in 13157 // C++03 depends on whether we get the C++03 version correct. The second 13158 // part does not apply to references, since they are not objects. 13159 if (E && IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context)) { 13160 // A reference initialized by a constant expression can never be 13161 // odr-used, so simply ignore it. 13162 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType()) 13163 SemaRef.MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(E); 13164 } else 13165 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, SemaRef, 13166 /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex ptr*/ nullptr); 13167 } 13168 13169 /// \brief Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 13170 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3). Note that this should not be 13171 /// used directly for normal expressions referring to VarDecl. 13172 void Sema::MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var) { 13173 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(*this, Loc, Var, nullptr); 13174 } 13175 13176 static void MarkExprReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 13177 Decl *D, Expr *E, bool OdrUse) { 13178 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 13179 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E); 13180 return; 13181 } 13182 13183 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, OdrUse); 13184 13185 // If this is a call to a method via a cast, also mark the method in the 13186 // derived class used in case codegen can devirtualize the call. 13187 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 13188 if (!ME) 13189 return; 13190 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 13191 if (!MD) 13192 return; 13193 // Only attempt to devirtualize if this is truly a virtual call. 13194 bool IsVirtualCall = MD->isVirtual() && !ME->hasQualifier(); 13195 if (!IsVirtualCall) 13196 return; 13197 const Expr *Base = ME->getBase(); 13198 const CXXRecordDecl *MostDerivedClassDecl = Base->getBestDynamicClassType(); 13199 if (!MostDerivedClassDecl) 13200 return; 13201 CXXMethodDecl *DM = MD->getCorrespondingMethodInClass(MostDerivedClassDecl); 13202 if (!DM || DM->isPure()) 13203 return; 13204 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, DM, OdrUse); 13205 } 13206 13207 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr. 13208 void Sema::MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E) { 13209 // TODO: update this with DR# once a defect report is filed. 13210 // C++11 defect. The address of a pure member should not be an ODR use, even 13211 // if it's a qualified reference. 13212 bool OdrUse = true; 13213 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getDecl())) 13214 if (Method->isVirtual()) 13215 OdrUse = false; 13216 MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getLocation(), E->getDecl(), E, OdrUse); 13217 } 13218 13219 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr. 13220 void Sema::MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E) { 13221 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p2: 13222 // A non-overloaded function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated 13223 // expression or a member of a set of candidate functions, if selected by 13224 // overload resolution when referred to from a potentially-evaluated 13225 // expression, is odr-used, unless it is a pure virtual function and its 13226 // name is not explicitly qualified. 13227 bool OdrUse = true; 13228 if (!E->hasQualifier()) { 13229 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl())) 13230 if (Method->isPure()) 13231 OdrUse = false; 13232 } 13233 SourceLocation Loc = E->getMemberLoc().isValid() ? 13234 E->getMemberLoc() : E->getLocStart(); 13235 MarkExprReferenced(*this, Loc, E->getMemberDecl(), E, OdrUse); 13236 } 13237 13238 /// \brief Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration. It 13239 /// marks the declaration referenced, and performs odr-use checking for 13240 /// functions and variables. This method should not be used when building a 13241 /// normal expression which refers to a variable. 13242 void Sema::MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, bool OdrUse) { 13243 if (OdrUse) { 13244 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 13245 MarkVariableReferenced(Loc, VD); 13246 return; 13247 } 13248 } 13249 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 13250 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, FD, OdrUse); 13251 return; 13252 } 13253 D->setReferenced(); 13254 } 13255 13256 namespace { 13257 // Mark all of the declarations referenced 13258 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding 13259 // of when we're entering 13260 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> { 13261 Sema &S; 13262 SourceLocation Loc; 13263 13264 public: 13265 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited; 13266 13267 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { } 13268 13269 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg); 13270 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T); 13271 }; 13272 } 13273 13274 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument( 13275 const TemplateArgument &Arg) { 13276 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) { 13277 if (Decl *D = Arg.getAsDecl()) 13278 S.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, true); 13279 } 13280 13281 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg); 13282 } 13283 13284 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) { 13285 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec 13286 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) { 13287 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs(); 13288 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size()); 13289 } 13290 13291 return true; 13292 } 13293 13294 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) { 13295 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc); 13296 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T)); 13297 } 13298 13299 namespace { 13300 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by 13301 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 13302 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> { 13303 Sema &S; 13304 bool SkipLocalVariables; 13305 13306 public: 13307 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited; 13308 13309 EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S, bool SkipLocalVariables) 13310 : Inherited(S.Context), S(S), SkipLocalVariables(SkipLocalVariables) { } 13311 13312 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 13313 // If we were asked not to visit local variables, don't. 13314 if (SkipLocalVariables) { 13315 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(E->getDecl())) 13316 if (VD->hasLocalStorage()) 13317 return; 13318 } 13319 13320 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 13321 } 13322 13323 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 13324 S.MarkMemberReferenced(E); 13325 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E); 13326 } 13327 13328 void VisitCXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXBindTemporaryExpr *E) { 13329 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), 13330 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(E->getTemporary()->getDestructor())); 13331 Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13332 } 13333 13334 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) { 13335 if (E->getOperatorNew()) 13336 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew()); 13337 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 13338 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 13339 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E); 13340 } 13341 13342 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) { 13343 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 13344 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 13345 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType()); 13346 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) { 13347 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl()); 13348 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), 13349 S.LookupDestructor(Record)); 13350 } 13351 13352 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E); 13353 } 13354 13355 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 13356 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor()); 13357 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 13358 } 13359 13360 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) { 13361 Visit(E->getExpr()); 13362 } 13363 13364 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 13365 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E); 13366 13367 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) 13368 S.UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E->getSubExpr()); 13369 } 13370 }; 13371 } 13372 13373 /// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any 13374 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 13375 /// 13376 /// \param SkipLocalVariables If true, don't mark local variables as 13377 /// 'referenced'. 13378 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E, 13379 bool SkipLocalVariables) { 13380 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this, SkipLocalVariables).Visit(E); 13381 } 13382 13383 /// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior 13384 /// of the program being compiled. 13385 /// 13386 /// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being 13387 /// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a 13388 /// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof() 13389 /// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not 13390 /// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or, 13391 /// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated 13392 /// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it 13393 /// later. 13394 /// 13395 /// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time 13396 /// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis. 13397 /// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures 13398 /// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid. 13399 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement, 13400 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) { 13401 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 13402 case Unevaluated: 13403 case UnevaluatedAbstract: 13404 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain. 13405 break; 13406 13407 case ConstantEvaluated: 13408 // Relevant diagnostics should be produced by constant evaluation. 13409 break; 13410 13411 case PotentiallyEvaluated: 13412 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 13413 if (Statement && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) { 13414 FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags. 13415 push_back(sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Statement)); 13416 } 13417 else 13418 Diag(Loc, PD); 13419 13420 return true; 13421 } 13422 13423 return false; 13424 } 13425 13426 bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc, 13427 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) { 13428 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType()) 13429 return false; 13430 13431 // If we're inside a decltype's expression, don't check for a valid return 13432 // type or construct temporaries until we know whether this is the last call. 13433 if (ExprEvalContexts.back().IsDecltype) { 13434 ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDecltypeCalls.push_back(CE); 13435 return false; 13436 } 13437 13438 class CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser { 13439 FunctionDecl *FD; 13440 CallExpr *CE; 13441 13442 public: 13443 CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *CE) 13444 : FD(FD), CE(CE) { } 13445 13446 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 13447 if (!FD) { 13448 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_incomplete_return) 13449 << T << CE->getSourceRange(); 13450 return; 13451 } 13452 13453 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return) 13454 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() << T; 13455 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 13456 << FD->getDeclName(); 13457 } 13458 } Diagnoser(FD, CE); 13459 13460 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType, Diagnoser)) 13461 return true; 13462 13463 return false; 13464 } 13465 13466 // Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses 13467 // will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want. 13468 void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) { 13469 SourceLocation Loc; 13470 13471 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment; 13472 bool IsOrAssign = false; 13473 13474 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 13475 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign) 13476 return; 13477 13478 IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign; 13479 13480 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory. 13481 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME 13482 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 13483 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector(); 13484 13485 // self = [<foo> init...] 13486 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && ME->getMethodFamily() == OMF_init) 13487 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 13488 13489 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject] 13490 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject") 13491 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 13492 } 13493 13494 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 13495 } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 13496 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual) 13497 return; 13498 13499 IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual; 13500 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 13501 } else if (PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E)) 13502 return DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(POE->getSyntacticForm()); 13503 else { 13504 // Not an assignment. 13505 return; 13506 } 13507 13508 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange(); 13509 13510 SourceLocation Open = E->getLocStart(); 13511 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 13512 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence) 13513 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(") 13514 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")"); 13515 13516 if (IsOrAssign) 13517 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison) 13518 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!="); 13519 else 13520 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison) 13521 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=="); 13522 } 13523 13524 /// \brief Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate 13525 /// that the user intended an assignment used as condition. 13526 void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) { 13527 // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro. 13528 SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getLocStart(); 13529 if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID()) 13530 return; 13531 // Don't warn for dependent expressions. 13532 if (ParenE->isTypeDependent()) 13533 return; 13534 13535 Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens(); 13536 13537 if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 13538 if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ && 13539 opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context) 13540 == Expr::MLV_Valid) { 13541 SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc(); 13542 13543 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange(); 13544 SourceRange ParenERange = ParenE->getSourceRange(); 13545 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence) 13546 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getBegin()) 13547 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getEnd()); 13548 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign) 13549 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "="); 13550 } 13551 } 13552 13553 ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 13554 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E); 13555 if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) 13556 DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE); 13557 13558 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 13559 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13560 E = result.get(); 13561 13562 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) { 13563 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13564 return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E); // C++ 6.4p4 13565 13566 ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 13567 if (ERes.isInvalid()) 13568 return ExprError(); 13569 E = ERes.get(); 13570 13571 QualType T = E->getType(); 13572 if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1 13573 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar) 13574 << T << E->getSourceRange(); 13575 return ExprError(); 13576 } 13577 CheckBoolLikeConversion(E, Loc); 13578 } 13579 13580 return E; 13581 } 13582 13583 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc, 13584 Expr *SubExpr) { 13585 if (!SubExpr) 13586 return ExprError(); 13587 13588 return CheckBooleanCondition(SubExpr, Loc); 13589 } 13590 13591 namespace { 13592 /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression 13593 /// to have an appropriate type. 13594 struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction 13595 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> { 13596 13597 Sema &S; 13598 13599 RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 13600 13601 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 13602 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 13603 } 13604 13605 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 13606 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call) 13607 << E->getSourceRange(); 13608 return ExprError(); 13609 } 13610 13611 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 13612 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 13613 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 13614 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13615 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13616 13617 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 13618 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 13619 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 13620 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 13621 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13622 return E; 13623 } 13624 13625 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 13626 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 13627 } 13628 13629 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 13630 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 13631 } 13632 13633 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 13634 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13635 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13636 13637 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 13638 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 13639 E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType())); 13640 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13641 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13642 return E; 13643 } 13644 13645 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 13646 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E); 13647 13648 E->setType(VD->getType()); 13649 13650 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13651 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 13652 !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) && 13653 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance())) 13654 E->setValueKind(VK_LValue); 13655 13656 return E; 13657 } 13658 13659 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 13660 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 13661 } 13662 13663 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 13664 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 13665 } 13666 }; 13667 } 13668 13669 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 13670 /// to have a function type. 13671 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) { 13672 ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr); 13673 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13674 return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.get()); 13675 } 13676 13677 namespace { 13678 /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype 13679 /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring 13680 /// expression. Strict preservation of the original source 13681 /// structure is not a goal. 13682 struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr 13683 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> { 13684 13685 Sema &S; 13686 13687 /// The current destination type. 13688 QualType DestType; 13689 13690 RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType) 13691 : S(S), DestType(CastType) {} 13692 13693 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 13694 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 13695 } 13696 13697 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 13698 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 13699 << E->getSourceRange(); 13700 return ExprError(); 13701 } 13702 13703 ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E); 13704 ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E); 13705 13706 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 13707 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 13708 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 13709 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13710 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13711 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 13712 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 13713 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 13714 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 13715 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13716 return E; 13717 } 13718 13719 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 13720 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 13721 } 13722 13723 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 13724 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 13725 } 13726 13727 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 13728 const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>(); 13729 if (!Ptr) { 13730 S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof) 13731 << E->getSourceRange(); 13732 return ExprError(); 13733 } 13734 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13735 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13736 E->setType(DestType); 13737 13738 // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type. 13739 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 13740 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13741 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13742 E->setSubExpr(SubResult.get()); 13743 return E; 13744 } 13745 13746 ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E); 13747 13748 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD); 13749 13750 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 13751 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 13752 } 13753 13754 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 13755 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 13756 } 13757 }; 13758 } 13759 13760 /// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype. 13761 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 13762 Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee(); 13763 13764 enum FnKind { 13765 FK_MemberFunction, 13766 FK_FunctionPointer, 13767 FK_BlockPointer 13768 }; 13769 13770 FnKind Kind; 13771 QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType(); 13772 if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) { 13773 assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)); 13774 Kind = FK_MemberFunction; 13775 CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr); 13776 } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 13777 CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 13778 Kind = FK_FunctionPointer; 13779 } else { 13780 CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 13781 Kind = FK_BlockPointer; 13782 } 13783 const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>(); 13784 13785 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function. 13786 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 13787 unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function; 13788 if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer) 13789 diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function; 13790 13791 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID) 13792 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 13793 return ExprError(); 13794 } 13795 13796 // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result. 13797 E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context)); 13798 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 13799 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13800 13801 // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType. 13802 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType); 13803 if (Proto) { 13804 // __unknown_anytype(...) is a special case used by the debugger when 13805 // it has no idea what a function's signature is. 13806 // 13807 // We want to build this call essentially under the K&R 13808 // unprototyped rules, but making a FunctionNoProtoType in C++ 13809 // would foul up all sorts of assumptions. However, we cannot 13810 // simply pass all arguments as variadic arguments, nor can we 13811 // portably just call the function under a non-variadic type; see 13812 // the comment on IR-gen's TargetInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic. 13813 // However, it turns out that in practice it is generally safe to 13814 // call a function declared as "A foo(B,C,D);" under the prototype 13815 // "A foo(B,C,D,...);". The only known exception is with the 13816 // Windows ABI, where any variadic function is implicitly cdecl 13817 // regardless of its normal CC. Therefore we change the parameter 13818 // types to match the types of the arguments. 13819 // 13820 // This is a hack, but it is far superior to moving the 13821 // corresponding target-specific code from IR-gen to Sema/AST. 13822 13823 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes = Proto->getParamTypes(); 13824 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes; 13825 if (ParamTypes.empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { // the special case 13826 ArgTypes.reserve(E->getNumArgs()); 13827 for (unsigned i = 0, e = E->getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) { 13828 Expr *Arg = E->getArg(i); 13829 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType(); 13830 if (E->isLValue()) { 13831 ArgType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArgType); 13832 } else if (E->isXValue()) { 13833 ArgType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(ArgType); 13834 } 13835 ArgTypes.push_back(ArgType); 13836 } 13837 ParamTypes = ArgTypes; 13838 } 13839 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType, ParamTypes, 13840 Proto->getExtProtoInfo()); 13841 } else { 13842 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType, 13843 FnType->getExtInfo()); 13844 } 13845 13846 // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type. 13847 switch (Kind) { 13848 case FK_MemberFunction: 13849 // Nothing to do. 13850 break; 13851 13852 case FK_FunctionPointer: 13853 DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType); 13854 break; 13855 13856 case FK_BlockPointer: 13857 DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType); 13858 break; 13859 } 13860 13861 // Finally, we can recurse. 13862 ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr); 13863 if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13864 E->setCallee(CalleeResult.get()); 13865 13866 // Bind a temporary if necessary. 13867 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 13868 } 13869 13870 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) { 13871 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call. 13872 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 13873 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function) 13874 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 13875 return ExprError(); 13876 } 13877 13878 // Rewrite the method result type if available. 13879 if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) { 13880 assert(Method->getReturnType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy); 13881 Method->setReturnType(DestType); 13882 } 13883 13884 // Change the type of the message. 13885 E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType()); 13886 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 13887 13888 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 13889 } 13890 13891 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 13892 // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay. 13893 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay) { 13894 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13895 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13896 13897 E->setType(DestType); 13898 13899 // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type. 13900 DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 13901 13902 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13903 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13904 13905 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 13906 return E; 13907 } else if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 13908 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13909 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13910 13911 assert(isa<BlockPointerType>(E->getType())); 13912 13913 E->setType(DestType); 13914 13915 // The sub-expression has to be a lvalue reference, so rebuild it as such. 13916 DestType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DestType); 13917 13918 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13919 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13920 13921 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 13922 return E; 13923 } else { 13924 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled cast type!"); 13925 } 13926 } 13927 13928 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 13929 ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue; 13930 QualType Type = DestType; 13931 13932 // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls: 13933 13934 // - functions 13935 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) { 13936 if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 13937 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 13938 ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD); 13939 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13940 return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), Type, 13941 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, VK_RValue); 13942 } 13943 13944 if (!Type->isFunctionType()) { 13945 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function) 13946 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 13947 return ExprError(); 13948 } 13949 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = Type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 13950 // We must match the FunctionDecl's type to the hack introduced in 13951 // RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr to vararg functions of unknown 13952 // type. See the lengthy commentary in that routine. 13953 QualType FDT = FD->getType(); 13954 const FunctionType *FnType = FDT->castAs<FunctionType>(); 13955 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FnType); 13956 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 13957 if (DRE && Proto && Proto->getParamTypes().empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { 13958 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 13959 FunctionDecl *NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(FD->getASTContext(), 13960 FD->getDeclContext(), 13961 Loc, Loc, FD->getNameInfo().getName(), 13962 DestType, FD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 13963 SC_None, false/*isInlineSpecified*/, 13964 FD->hasPrototype(), 13965 false/*isConstexprSpecified*/); 13966 13967 if (FD->getQualifier()) 13968 NewFD->setQualifierInfo(FD->getQualifierLoc()); 13969 13970 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 13971 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 13972 ParmVarDecl *Param = 13973 S.BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(FD, Loc, AI); 13974 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 13975 Params.push_back(Param); 13976 } 13977 NewFD->setParams(Params); 13978 DRE->setDecl(NewFD); 13979 VD = DRE->getDecl(); 13980 } 13981 } 13982 13983 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 13984 if (MD->isInstance()) { 13985 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 13986 Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy; 13987 } 13988 13989 // Function references aren't l-values in C. 13990 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13991 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 13992 13993 // - variables 13994 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) { 13995 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 13996 Type = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 13997 } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) { 13998 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type) 13999 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 14000 return ExprError(); 14001 } 14002 14003 // - nothing else 14004 } else { 14005 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl) 14006 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 14007 return ExprError(); 14008 } 14009 14010 // Modifying the declaration like this is friendly to IR-gen but 14011 // also really dangerous. 14012 VD->setType(DestType); 14013 E->setType(Type); 14014 E->setValueKind(ValueKind); 14015 return E; 14016 } 14017 14018 /// Check a cast of an unknown-any type. We intentionally only 14019 /// trigger this for C-style casts. 14020 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType, 14021 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind, 14022 ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) { 14023 // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch. 14024 ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr); 14025 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 14026 14027 CastExpr = result.get(); 14028 VK = CastExpr->getValueKind(); 14029 CastKind = CK_NoOp; 14030 14031 return CastExpr; 14032 } 14033 14034 ExprResult Sema::forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType) { 14035 return RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, ToType).Visit(E); 14036 } 14037 14038 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc, 14039 Expr *arg, QualType ¶mType) { 14040 // If the syntactic form of the argument is not an explicit cast of 14041 // any sort, just do default argument promotion. 14042 ExplicitCastExpr *castArg = dyn_cast<ExplicitCastExpr>(arg->IgnoreParens()); 14043 if (!castArg) { 14044 ExprResult result = DefaultArgumentPromotion(arg); 14045 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 14046 paramType = result.get()->getType(); 14047 return result; 14048 } 14049 14050 // Otherwise, use the type that was written in the explicit cast. 14051 assert(!arg->hasPlaceholderType()); 14052 paramType = castArg->getTypeAsWritten(); 14053 14054 // Copy-initialize a parameter of that type. 14055 InitializedEntity entity = 14056 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, paramType, 14057 /*consumed*/ false); 14058 return PerformCopyInitialization(entity, callLoc, arg); 14059 } 14060 14061 static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 14062 Expr *orig = E; 14063 unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any; 14064 while (true) { 14065 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 14066 if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 14067 E = call->getCallee(); 14068 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 14069 } else { 14070 break; 14071 } 14072 } 14073 14074 SourceLocation loc; 14075 NamedDecl *d; 14076 if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 14077 loc = ref->getLocation(); 14078 d = ref->getDecl(); 14079 } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 14080 loc = mem->getMemberLoc(); 14081 d = mem->getMemberDecl(); 14082 } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) { 14083 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 14084 loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc(); 14085 d = msg->getMethodDecl(); 14086 if (!d) { 14087 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method) 14088 << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector() 14089 << orig->getSourceRange(); 14090 return ExprError(); 14091 } 14092 } else { 14093 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 14094 << E->getSourceRange(); 14095 return ExprError(); 14096 } 14097 14098 S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange(); 14099 14100 // Never recoverable. 14101 return ExprError(); 14102 } 14103 14104 /// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found. 14105 /// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible. 14106 ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) { 14107 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 14108 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it 14109 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 14110 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 14111 ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(E); 14112 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 14113 E = Result.get(); 14114 } 14115 14116 const BuiltinType *placeholderType = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType(); 14117 if (!placeholderType) return E; 14118 14119 switch (placeholderType->getKind()) { 14120 14121 // Overloaded expressions. 14122 case BuiltinType::Overload: { 14123 // Try to resolve a single function template specialization. 14124 // This is obligatory. 14125 ExprResult result = E; 14126 if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(result, false)) { 14127 return result; 14128 14129 // If that failed, try to recover with a call. 14130 } else { 14131 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable), 14132 /*complain*/ true); 14133 return result; 14134 } 14135 } 14136 14137 // Bound member functions. 14138 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: { 14139 ExprResult result = E; 14140 const Expr *BME = E->IgnoreParens(); 14141 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function); 14142 // Try to give a nicer diagnostic if it is a bound member that we recognize. 14143 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(BME)) { 14144 PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*pseudo-destructor*/ 1; 14145 } else if (const auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(BME)) { 14146 if (ME->getMemberNameInfo().getName().getNameKind() == 14147 DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) 14148 PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*destructor*/ 0; 14149 } 14150 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PD, 14151 /*complain*/ true); 14152 return result; 14153 } 14154 14155 // ARC unbridged casts. 14156 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: { 14157 Expr *realCast = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 14158 diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(realCast); 14159 return realCast; 14160 } 14161 14162 // Expressions of unknown type. 14163 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 14164 return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E); 14165 14166 // Pseudo-objects. 14167 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 14168 return checkPseudoObjectRValue(E); 14169 14170 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: { 14171 // Accept __noop without parens by implicitly converting it to a call expr. 14172 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 14173 if (DRE) { 14174 auto *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 14175 if (FD->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__noop) { 14176 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(FD->getType()), 14177 CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get(); 14178 return new (Context) CallExpr(Context, E, None, Context.IntTy, 14179 VK_RValue, SourceLocation()); 14180 } 14181 } 14182 14183 Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_builtin_fn_use); 14184 return ExprError(); 14185 } 14186 14187 // Everything else should be impossible. 14188 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) \ 14189 case BuiltinType::Id: 14190 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) 14191 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 14192 break; 14193 } 14194 14195 llvm_unreachable("invalid placeholder type!"); 14196 } 14197 14198 bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) { 14199 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 14200 return true; 14201 if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) 14202 return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType(); 14203 return false; 14204 } 14205 14206 /// ActOnObjCBoolLiteral - Parse {__objc_yes,__objc_no} literals. 14207 ExprResult 14208 Sema::ActOnObjCBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 14209 assert((Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes || Kind == tok::kw___objc_no) && 14210 "Unknown Objective-C Boolean value!"); 14211 QualType BoolT = Context.ObjCBuiltinBoolTy; 14212 if (!Context.getBOOLDecl()) { 14213 LookupResult Result(*this, &Context.Idents.get("BOOL"), OpLoc, 14214 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 14215 if (LookupName(Result, getCurScope()) && Result.isSingleResult()) { 14216 NamedDecl *ND = Result.getFoundDecl(); 14217 if (TypedefDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(ND)) 14218 Context.setBOOLDecl(TD); 14219 } 14220 } 14221 if (Context.getBOOLDecl()) 14222 BoolT = Context.getBOOLType(); 14223 return new (Context) 14224 ObjCBoolLiteralExpr(Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes, BoolT, OpLoc); 14225 } 14226